US20050002448A1 - Method and apparatus for non-conductively interconnecting integrated circuits - Google Patents
Method and apparatus for non-conductively interconnecting integrated circuits Download PDFInfo
- Publication number
- US20050002448A1 US20050002448A1 US10/834,352 US83435204A US2005002448A1 US 20050002448 A1 US20050002448 A1 US 20050002448A1 US 83435204 A US83435204 A US 83435204A US 2005002448 A1 US2005002448 A1 US 2005002448A1
- Authority
- US
- United States
- Prior art keywords
- die
- substrate
- module
- dies
- modules
- Prior art date
- Legal status (The legal status is an assumption and is not a legal conclusion. Google has not performed a legal analysis and makes no representation as to the accuracy of the status listed.)
- Abandoned
Links
Images
Classifications
-
- H—ELECTRICITY
- H01—ELECTRIC ELEMENTS
- H01L—SEMICONDUCTOR DEVICES NOT COVERED BY CLASS H10
- H01L24/00—Arrangements for connecting or disconnecting semiconductor or solid-state bodies; Methods or apparatus related thereto
- H01L24/73—Means for bonding being of different types provided for in two or more of groups H01L24/10, H01L24/18, H01L24/26, H01L24/34, H01L24/42, H01L24/50, H01L24/63, H01L24/71
-
- G—PHYSICS
- G01—MEASURING; TESTING
- G01R—MEASURING ELECTRIC VARIABLES; MEASURING MAGNETIC VARIABLES
- G01R31/00—Arrangements for testing electric properties; Arrangements for locating electric faults; Arrangements for electrical testing characterised by what is being tested not provided for elsewhere
- G01R31/28—Testing of electronic circuits, e.g. by signal tracer
- G01R31/302—Contactless testing
- G01R31/3025—Wireless interface with the DUT
-
- G—PHYSICS
- G01—MEASURING; TESTING
- G01R—MEASURING ELECTRIC VARIABLES; MEASURING MAGNETIC VARIABLES
- G01R31/00—Arrangements for testing electric properties; Arrangements for locating electric faults; Arrangements for electrical testing characterised by what is being tested not provided for elsewhere
- G01R31/28—Testing of electronic circuits, e.g. by signal tracer
- G01R31/302—Contactless testing
- G01R31/312—Contactless testing by capacitive methods
-
- G—PHYSICS
- G01—MEASURING; TESTING
- G01R—MEASURING ELECTRIC VARIABLES; MEASURING MAGNETIC VARIABLES
- G01R31/00—Arrangements for testing electric properties; Arrangements for locating electric faults; Arrangements for electrical testing characterised by what is being tested not provided for elsewhere
- G01R31/28—Testing of electronic circuits, e.g. by signal tracer
- G01R31/317—Testing of digital circuits
- G01R31/3181—Functional testing
- G01R31/3185—Reconfiguring for testing, e.g. LSSD, partitioning
- G01R31/318505—Test of Modular systems, e.g. Wafers, MCM's
- G01R31/318513—Test of Multi-Chip-Moduls
-
- H—ELECTRICITY
- H01—ELECTRIC ELEMENTS
- H01L—SEMICONDUCTOR DEVICES NOT COVERED BY CLASS H10
- H01L23/00—Details of semiconductor or other solid state devices
- H01L23/48—Arrangements for conducting electric current to or from the solid state body in operation, e.g. leads, terminal arrangements ; Selection of materials therefor
-
- H—ELECTRICITY
- H01—ELECTRIC ELEMENTS
- H01L—SEMICONDUCTOR DEVICES NOT COVERED BY CLASS H10
- H01L23/00—Details of semiconductor or other solid state devices
- H01L23/52—Arrangements for conducting electric current within the device in operation from one component to another, i.e. interconnections, e.g. wires, lead frames
- H01L23/538—Arrangements for conducting electric current within the device in operation from one component to another, i.e. interconnections, e.g. wires, lead frames the interconnection structure between a plurality of semiconductor chips being formed on, or in, insulating substrates
- H01L23/5385—Assembly of a plurality of insulating substrates
-
- H—ELECTRICITY
- H01—ELECTRIC ELEMENTS
- H01L—SEMICONDUCTOR DEVICES NOT COVERED BY CLASS H10
- H01L23/00—Details of semiconductor or other solid state devices
- H01L23/58—Structural electrical arrangements for semiconductor devices not otherwise provided for, e.g. in combination with batteries
- H01L23/64—Impedance arrangements
- H01L23/642—Capacitive arrangements
-
- H—ELECTRICITY
- H01—ELECTRIC ELEMENTS
- H01L—SEMICONDUCTOR DEVICES NOT COVERED BY CLASS H10
- H01L2224/00—Indexing scheme for arrangements for connecting or disconnecting semiconductor or solid-state bodies and methods related thereto as covered by H01L24/00
- H01L2224/01—Means for bonding being attached to, or being formed on, the surface to be connected, e.g. chip-to-package, die-attach, "first-level" interconnects; Manufacturing methods related thereto
- H01L2224/10—Bump connectors; Manufacturing methods related thereto
- H01L2224/15—Structure, shape, material or disposition of the bump connectors after the connecting process
- H01L2224/16—Structure, shape, material or disposition of the bump connectors after the connecting process of an individual bump connector
-
- H—ELECTRICITY
- H01—ELECTRIC ELEMENTS
- H01L—SEMICONDUCTOR DEVICES NOT COVERED BY CLASS H10
- H01L2224/00—Indexing scheme for arrangements for connecting or disconnecting semiconductor or solid-state bodies and methods related thereto as covered by H01L24/00
- H01L2224/01—Means for bonding being attached to, or being formed on, the surface to be connected, e.g. chip-to-package, die-attach, "first-level" interconnects; Manufacturing methods related thereto
- H01L2224/26—Layer connectors, e.g. plate connectors, solder or adhesive layers; Manufacturing methods related thereto
- H01L2224/31—Structure, shape, material or disposition of the layer connectors after the connecting process
- H01L2224/32—Structure, shape, material or disposition of the layer connectors after the connecting process of an individual layer connector
- H01L2224/321—Disposition
- H01L2224/32151—Disposition the layer connector connecting between a semiconductor or solid-state body and an item not being a semiconductor or solid-state body, e.g. chip-to-substrate, chip-to-passive
- H01L2224/32221—Disposition the layer connector connecting between a semiconductor or solid-state body and an item not being a semiconductor or solid-state body, e.g. chip-to-substrate, chip-to-passive the body and the item being stacked
- H01L2224/32225—Disposition the layer connector connecting between a semiconductor or solid-state body and an item not being a semiconductor or solid-state body, e.g. chip-to-substrate, chip-to-passive the body and the item being stacked the item being non-metallic, e.g. insulating substrate with or without metallisation
-
- H—ELECTRICITY
- H01—ELECTRIC ELEMENTS
- H01L—SEMICONDUCTOR DEVICES NOT COVERED BY CLASS H10
- H01L2224/00—Indexing scheme for arrangements for connecting or disconnecting semiconductor or solid-state bodies and methods related thereto as covered by H01L24/00
- H01L2224/01—Means for bonding being attached to, or being formed on, the surface to be connected, e.g. chip-to-package, die-attach, "first-level" interconnects; Manufacturing methods related thereto
- H01L2224/42—Wire connectors; Manufacturing methods related thereto
- H01L2224/44—Structure, shape, material or disposition of the wire connectors prior to the connecting process
- H01L2224/45—Structure, shape, material or disposition of the wire connectors prior to the connecting process of an individual wire connector
- H01L2224/45001—Core members of the connector
- H01L2224/45099—Material
- H01L2224/451—Material with a principal constituent of the material being a metal or a metalloid, e.g. boron (B), silicon (Si), germanium (Ge), arsenic (As), antimony (Sb), tellurium (Te) and polonium (Po), and alloys thereof
- H01L2224/45138—Material with a principal constituent of the material being a metal or a metalloid, e.g. boron (B), silicon (Si), germanium (Ge), arsenic (As), antimony (Sb), tellurium (Te) and polonium (Po), and alloys thereof the principal constituent melting at a temperature of greater than or equal to 950°C and less than 1550°C
- H01L2224/45144—Gold (Au) as principal constituent
-
- H—ELECTRICITY
- H01—ELECTRIC ELEMENTS
- H01L—SEMICONDUCTOR DEVICES NOT COVERED BY CLASS H10
- H01L2924/00—Indexing scheme for arrangements or methods for connecting or disconnecting semiconductor or solid-state bodies as covered by H01L24/00
- H01L2924/01—Chemical elements
- H01L2924/01004—Beryllium [Be]
-
- H—ELECTRICITY
- H01—ELECTRIC ELEMENTS
- H01L—SEMICONDUCTOR DEVICES NOT COVERED BY CLASS H10
- H01L2924/00—Indexing scheme for arrangements or methods for connecting or disconnecting semiconductor or solid-state bodies as covered by H01L24/00
- H01L2924/01—Chemical elements
- H01L2924/01005—Boron [B]
-
- H—ELECTRICITY
- H01—ELECTRIC ELEMENTS
- H01L—SEMICONDUCTOR DEVICES NOT COVERED BY CLASS H10
- H01L2924/00—Indexing scheme for arrangements or methods for connecting or disconnecting semiconductor or solid-state bodies as covered by H01L24/00
- H01L2924/01—Chemical elements
- H01L2924/01006—Carbon [C]
-
- H—ELECTRICITY
- H01—ELECTRIC ELEMENTS
- H01L—SEMICONDUCTOR DEVICES NOT COVERED BY CLASS H10
- H01L2924/00—Indexing scheme for arrangements or methods for connecting or disconnecting semiconductor or solid-state bodies as covered by H01L24/00
- H01L2924/01—Chemical elements
- H01L2924/01013—Aluminum [Al]
-
- H—ELECTRICITY
- H01—ELECTRIC ELEMENTS
- H01L—SEMICONDUCTOR DEVICES NOT COVERED BY CLASS H10
- H01L2924/00—Indexing scheme for arrangements or methods for connecting or disconnecting semiconductor or solid-state bodies as covered by H01L24/00
- H01L2924/01—Chemical elements
- H01L2924/01019—Potassium [K]
-
- H—ELECTRICITY
- H01—ELECTRIC ELEMENTS
- H01L—SEMICONDUCTOR DEVICES NOT COVERED BY CLASS H10
- H01L2924/00—Indexing scheme for arrangements or methods for connecting or disconnecting semiconductor or solid-state bodies as covered by H01L24/00
- H01L2924/01—Chemical elements
- H01L2924/01029—Copper [Cu]
-
- H—ELECTRICITY
- H01—ELECTRIC ELEMENTS
- H01L—SEMICONDUCTOR DEVICES NOT COVERED BY CLASS H10
- H01L2924/00—Indexing scheme for arrangements or methods for connecting or disconnecting semiconductor or solid-state bodies as covered by H01L24/00
- H01L2924/01—Chemical elements
- H01L2924/01032—Germanium [Ge]
-
- H—ELECTRICITY
- H01—ELECTRIC ELEMENTS
- H01L—SEMICONDUCTOR DEVICES NOT COVERED BY CLASS H10
- H01L2924/00—Indexing scheme for arrangements or methods for connecting or disconnecting semiconductor or solid-state bodies as covered by H01L24/00
- H01L2924/01—Chemical elements
- H01L2924/01033—Arsenic [As]
-
- H—ELECTRICITY
- H01—ELECTRIC ELEMENTS
- H01L—SEMICONDUCTOR DEVICES NOT COVERED BY CLASS H10
- H01L2924/00—Indexing scheme for arrangements or methods for connecting or disconnecting semiconductor or solid-state bodies as covered by H01L24/00
- H01L2924/01—Chemical elements
- H01L2924/01039—Yttrium [Y]
-
- H—ELECTRICITY
- H01—ELECTRIC ELEMENTS
- H01L—SEMICONDUCTOR DEVICES NOT COVERED BY CLASS H10
- H01L2924/00—Indexing scheme for arrangements or methods for connecting or disconnecting semiconductor or solid-state bodies as covered by H01L24/00
- H01L2924/01—Chemical elements
- H01L2924/01043—Technetium [Tc]
-
- H—ELECTRICITY
- H01—ELECTRIC ELEMENTS
- H01L—SEMICONDUCTOR DEVICES NOT COVERED BY CLASS H10
- H01L2924/00—Indexing scheme for arrangements or methods for connecting or disconnecting semiconductor or solid-state bodies as covered by H01L24/00
- H01L2924/01—Chemical elements
- H01L2924/01047—Silver [Ag]
-
- H—ELECTRICITY
- H01—ELECTRIC ELEMENTS
- H01L—SEMICONDUCTOR DEVICES NOT COVERED BY CLASS H10
- H01L2924/00—Indexing scheme for arrangements or methods for connecting or disconnecting semiconductor or solid-state bodies as covered by H01L24/00
- H01L2924/01—Chemical elements
- H01L2924/01056—Barium [Ba]
-
- H—ELECTRICITY
- H01—ELECTRIC ELEMENTS
- H01L—SEMICONDUCTOR DEVICES NOT COVERED BY CLASS H10
- H01L2924/00—Indexing scheme for arrangements or methods for connecting or disconnecting semiconductor or solid-state bodies as covered by H01L24/00
- H01L2924/01—Chemical elements
- H01L2924/01074—Tungsten [W]
-
- H—ELECTRICITY
- H01—ELECTRIC ELEMENTS
- H01L—SEMICONDUCTOR DEVICES NOT COVERED BY CLASS H10
- H01L2924/00—Indexing scheme for arrangements or methods for connecting or disconnecting semiconductor or solid-state bodies as covered by H01L24/00
- H01L2924/01—Chemical elements
- H01L2924/01075—Rhenium [Re]
-
- H—ELECTRICITY
- H01—ELECTRIC ELEMENTS
- H01L—SEMICONDUCTOR DEVICES NOT COVERED BY CLASS H10
- H01L2924/00—Indexing scheme for arrangements or methods for connecting or disconnecting semiconductor or solid-state bodies as covered by H01L24/00
- H01L2924/01—Chemical elements
- H01L2924/01079—Gold [Au]
-
- H—ELECTRICITY
- H01—ELECTRIC ELEMENTS
- H01L—SEMICONDUCTOR DEVICES NOT COVERED BY CLASS H10
- H01L2924/00—Indexing scheme for arrangements or methods for connecting or disconnecting semiconductor or solid-state bodies as covered by H01L24/00
- H01L2924/01—Chemical elements
- H01L2924/01082—Lead [Pb]
-
- H—ELECTRICITY
- H01—ELECTRIC ELEMENTS
- H01L—SEMICONDUCTOR DEVICES NOT COVERED BY CLASS H10
- H01L2924/00—Indexing scheme for arrangements or methods for connecting or disconnecting semiconductor or solid-state bodies as covered by H01L24/00
- H01L2924/01—Chemical elements
- H01L2924/01087—Francium [Fr]
-
- H—ELECTRICITY
- H01—ELECTRIC ELEMENTS
- H01L—SEMICONDUCTOR DEVICES NOT COVERED BY CLASS H10
- H01L2924/00—Indexing scheme for arrangements or methods for connecting or disconnecting semiconductor or solid-state bodies as covered by H01L24/00
- H01L2924/01—Chemical elements
- H01L2924/01092—Uranium [U]
-
- H—ELECTRICITY
- H01—ELECTRIC ELEMENTS
- H01L—SEMICONDUCTOR DEVICES NOT COVERED BY CLASS H10
- H01L2924/00—Indexing scheme for arrangements or methods for connecting or disconnecting semiconductor or solid-state bodies as covered by H01L24/00
- H01L2924/013—Alloys
- H01L2924/0132—Binary Alloys
- H01L2924/01322—Eutectic Alloys, i.e. obtained by a liquid transforming into two solid phases
-
- H—ELECTRICITY
- H01—ELECTRIC ELEMENTS
- H01L—SEMICONDUCTOR DEVICES NOT COVERED BY CLASS H10
- H01L2924/00—Indexing scheme for arrangements or methods for connecting or disconnecting semiconductor or solid-state bodies as covered by H01L24/00
- H01L2924/013—Alloys
- H01L2924/0132—Binary Alloys
- H01L2924/01327—Intermediate phases, i.e. intermetallics compounds
-
- H—ELECTRICITY
- H01—ELECTRIC ELEMENTS
- H01L—SEMICONDUCTOR DEVICES NOT COVERED BY CLASS H10
- H01L2924/00—Indexing scheme for arrangements or methods for connecting or disconnecting semiconductor or solid-state bodies as covered by H01L24/00
- H01L2924/10—Details of semiconductor or other solid state devices to be connected
- H01L2924/102—Material of the semiconductor or solid state bodies
- H01L2924/1025—Semiconducting materials
- H01L2924/10251—Elemental semiconductors, i.e. Group IV
- H01L2924/10253—Silicon [Si]
-
- H—ELECTRICITY
- H01—ELECTRIC ELEMENTS
- H01L—SEMICONDUCTOR DEVICES NOT COVERED BY CLASS H10
- H01L2924/00—Indexing scheme for arrangements or methods for connecting or disconnecting semiconductor or solid-state bodies as covered by H01L24/00
- H01L2924/10—Details of semiconductor or other solid state devices to be connected
- H01L2924/102—Material of the semiconductor or solid state bodies
- H01L2924/1025—Semiconducting materials
- H01L2924/1026—Compound semiconductors
- H01L2924/1032—III-V
- H01L2924/10329—Gallium arsenide [GaAs]
-
- H—ELECTRICITY
- H01—ELECTRIC ELEMENTS
- H01L—SEMICONDUCTOR DEVICES NOT COVERED BY CLASS H10
- H01L2924/00—Indexing scheme for arrangements or methods for connecting or disconnecting semiconductor or solid-state bodies as covered by H01L24/00
- H01L2924/10—Details of semiconductor or other solid state devices to be connected
- H01L2924/11—Device type
- H01L2924/12—Passive devices, e.g. 2 terminal devices
- H01L2924/1203—Rectifying Diode
- H01L2924/12036—PN diode
-
- H—ELECTRICITY
- H01—ELECTRIC ELEMENTS
- H01L—SEMICONDUCTOR DEVICES NOT COVERED BY CLASS H10
- H01L2924/00—Indexing scheme for arrangements or methods for connecting or disconnecting semiconductor or solid-state bodies as covered by H01L24/00
- H01L2924/10—Details of semiconductor or other solid state devices to be connected
- H01L2924/11—Device type
- H01L2924/12—Passive devices, e.g. 2 terminal devices
- H01L2924/1204—Optical Diode
- H01L2924/12042—LASER
-
- H—ELECTRICITY
- H01—ELECTRIC ELEMENTS
- H01L—SEMICONDUCTOR DEVICES NOT COVERED BY CLASS H10
- H01L2924/00—Indexing scheme for arrangements or methods for connecting or disconnecting semiconductor or solid-state bodies as covered by H01L24/00
- H01L2924/10—Details of semiconductor or other solid state devices to be connected
- H01L2924/11—Device type
- H01L2924/13—Discrete devices, e.g. 3 terminal devices
- H01L2924/1304—Transistor
- H01L2924/1306—Field-effect transistor [FET]
- H01L2924/13091—Metal-Oxide-Semiconductor Field-Effect Transistor [MOSFET]
-
- H—ELECTRICITY
- H01—ELECTRIC ELEMENTS
- H01L—SEMICONDUCTOR DEVICES NOT COVERED BY CLASS H10
- H01L2924/00—Indexing scheme for arrangements or methods for connecting or disconnecting semiconductor or solid-state bodies as covered by H01L24/00
- H01L2924/10—Details of semiconductor or other solid state devices to be connected
- H01L2924/11—Device type
- H01L2924/14—Integrated circuits
-
- H—ELECTRICITY
- H01—ELECTRIC ELEMENTS
- H01L—SEMICONDUCTOR DEVICES NOT COVERED BY CLASS H10
- H01L2924/00—Indexing scheme for arrangements or methods for connecting or disconnecting semiconductor or solid-state bodies as covered by H01L24/00
- H01L2924/10—Details of semiconductor or other solid state devices to be connected
- H01L2924/11—Device type
- H01L2924/14—Integrated circuits
- H01L2924/143—Digital devices
- H01L2924/1433—Application-specific integrated circuit [ASIC]
-
- H—ELECTRICITY
- H01—ELECTRIC ELEMENTS
- H01L—SEMICONDUCTOR DEVICES NOT COVERED BY CLASS H10
- H01L2924/00—Indexing scheme for arrangements or methods for connecting or disconnecting semiconductor or solid-state bodies as covered by H01L24/00
- H01L2924/15—Details of package parts other than the semiconductor or other solid state devices to be connected
- H01L2924/151—Die mounting substrate
- H01L2924/156—Material
- H01L2924/15786—Material with a principal constituent of the material being a non metallic, non metalloid inorganic material
- H01L2924/15787—Ceramics, e.g. crystalline carbides, nitrides or oxides
-
- H—ELECTRICITY
- H01—ELECTRIC ELEMENTS
- H01L—SEMICONDUCTOR DEVICES NOT COVERED BY CLASS H10
- H01L2924/00—Indexing scheme for arrangements or methods for connecting or disconnecting semiconductor or solid-state bodies as covered by H01L24/00
- H01L2924/15—Details of package parts other than the semiconductor or other solid state devices to be connected
- H01L2924/181—Encapsulation
-
- H—ELECTRICITY
- H01—ELECTRIC ELEMENTS
- H01L—SEMICONDUCTOR DEVICES NOT COVERED BY CLASS H10
- H01L2924/00—Indexing scheme for arrangements or methods for connecting or disconnecting semiconductor or solid-state bodies as covered by H01L24/00
- H01L2924/19—Details of hybrid assemblies other than the semiconductor or other solid state devices to be connected
- H01L2924/1901—Structure
- H01L2924/1904—Component type
- H01L2924/19041—Component type being a capacitor
-
- H—ELECTRICITY
- H01—ELECTRIC ELEMENTS
- H01L—SEMICONDUCTOR DEVICES NOT COVERED BY CLASS H10
- H01L2924/00—Indexing scheme for arrangements or methods for connecting or disconnecting semiconductor or solid-state bodies as covered by H01L24/00
- H01L2924/30—Technical effects
- H01L2924/301—Electrical effects
- H01L2924/30107—Inductance
-
- H—ELECTRICITY
- H01—ELECTRIC ELEMENTS
- H01L—SEMICONDUCTOR DEVICES NOT COVERED BY CLASS H10
- H01L2924/00—Indexing scheme for arrangements or methods for connecting or disconnecting semiconductor or solid-state bodies as covered by H01L24/00
- H01L2924/30—Technical effects
- H01L2924/301—Electrical effects
- H01L2924/3011—Impedance
-
- H—ELECTRICITY
- H01—ELECTRIC ELEMENTS
- H01L—SEMICONDUCTOR DEVICES NOT COVERED BY CLASS H10
- H01L2924/00—Indexing scheme for arrangements or methods for connecting or disconnecting semiconductor or solid-state bodies as covered by H01L24/00
- H01L2924/30—Technical effects
- H01L2924/301—Electrical effects
- H01L2924/3025—Electromagnetic shielding
-
- H—ELECTRICITY
- H01—ELECTRIC ELEMENTS
- H01L—SEMICONDUCTOR DEVICES NOT COVERED BY CLASS H10
- H01L2924/00—Indexing scheme for arrangements or methods for connecting or disconnecting semiconductor or solid-state bodies as covered by H01L24/00
- H01L2924/30—Technical effects
- H01L2924/35—Mechanical effects
- H01L2924/351—Thermal stress
-
- Y—GENERAL TAGGING OF NEW TECHNOLOGICAL DEVELOPMENTS; GENERAL TAGGING OF CROSS-SECTIONAL TECHNOLOGIES SPANNING OVER SEVERAL SECTIONS OF THE IPC; TECHNICAL SUBJECTS COVERED BY FORMER USPC CROSS-REFERENCE ART COLLECTIONS [XRACs] AND DIGESTS
- Y10—TECHNICAL SUBJECTS COVERED BY FORMER USPC
- Y10S—TECHNICAL SUBJECTS COVERED BY FORMER USPC CROSS-REFERENCE ART COLLECTIONS [XRACs] AND DIGESTS
- Y10S257/00—Active solid-state devices, e.g. transistors, solid-state diodes
- Y10S257/924—Active solid-state devices, e.g. transistors, solid-state diodes with passive device, e.g. capacitor, or battery, as integral part of housing or housing element, e.g. cap
Definitions
- the present invention relates generally to the field of electronic and microelectronic packaging and, more particularly, to a multichip package, a method for assembling, testing and repairing systems so packaged, and a method for communicating between circuits so packaged, via capacitive coupling.
- digital systems meaning systems which contain important constituents that operate according to the rules of multistate or binary logic.
- Electronic systems are usually implemented as hierarchical packages of components. Passive or active electronic elements, such as resistors and transistors, and their wiring are typically combined into memory or logic units, which are then combined into circuits and devices, which are combined into larger functional units, and so forth up to the level of a system.
- Each higher level of hierarchy grants the designer greater productivity, but compounds costs for connecting packages together logically and physically. Communication of data and timing among devices at each of these levels requires signal interconnection means, which the package provides. The package also provides powering means and fulfills other requirements such as physical support, heat removal and protection.
- Level 0 an exemplary scale in the hardware system hierarchy is the naked semiconductor wafer, sometimes called an undiced “Level 0” package.
- Many components are formed simultaneously on a common substrate during fabrication stages, even if the substrate is subsequently separated into subunits. For instance, wiring, memory or logic gates may be assembled into integrated circuits on the surface of a semiconductor wafer and then cut into individual dies. Examples of dies include microelectronic devices implemented on semiconductor materials, superconductors bearing Josephson Junctions, and materials bearing other quantum interference devices.
- Level 1 packages which provide mechanical stability, protection, cooling and heat dissipation, power and grounding, and interconnection of signal lines (including clocking) to other packages.
- Examples include DIP, ceramic, surface mounted and socketed packages.
- a “Level 2” package is a module carrying one or more Level 1 or Level 0 packages and interconnecting their signal and power wiring. It typically comprises a printed circuit board (PCB), a printed wiring board (PWB), or a thermal conduction module, and may cluster one or more interconnected packages for these purposes. “Level 3” assemblies further organize the Level 1 and Level 2 packages, typically with backplanes, but do not differ conceptually from Level 2 or Level 1 packages. The “Level 4” package canonically ties together the lower level packages with power supplies, environmental systems, mechanical systems, peripherals, and so forth to provide system functionality.
- a multichip module (“MCM” or “Level 11 ⁇ 2” package) provides modular functionality as a Level 2-like or Level 3-like package for holding and interconnecting multiple dies and/or associated interconnections.
- MCM multichip module
- the MCM may also, or merely, encapsulate its constituent dies as an expectingwhile Level 1 or Level 0 package, thereby providing protection. It may also communicate the dies to a heat sinking substrate, thereby providing heat dissipation.
- an MCM could be treated as a package at any level of hierarchy, as defined in practice by its interconnection topology.
- chip is used interchangeably in the industry both in reference to Level 0 dies and Level 1 packages (e.g., a multichip module is usually in fact a multidie module).
- the term chip refers to a Level 0 package or die unless context indicates otherwise.
- module or “submodule” as used herein is intended to be general, and can refer to any package level, for example one or more Level 0 dies, one or more Level 1 or Level 0 chips (packaged or not), and of course higher order ensembles.
- An MCM involves two or more dies, whether bare or encapsulated, mounted and conductively coupled to it. It provides power and inter-die signal wiring.
- the dies are physically bonded to a substrate, and leads that are wire-bonded to peripherally positioned contacts (e.g., pins) supply the conductive connections between the dies and a multichip substrate.
- peripherally positioned contacts e.g., pins
- Other technologies utilize a “flip-chip” configuration in which the leads of the dies are positioned either peripherally or over much of the die area (such as a pin grid array (PGA) or solder bumps) and are soldered or otherwise bonded to respective contacts on the multichip substrate.
- PGA pin grid array
- MCM-L multichip packaging technology
- TAB tape automatic bonding
- wire-bonding wire-bonding
- MCM-C multichip packaging technology
- dies are attached either directly by flip-chip or indirectly in prepackaged carriers to a ceramic thick-filmed substrate.
- the ceramic substrate is formed either sequentially, by a print and fire process, or by lamination and sequential co-insertion of screened green sheets.
- MCM-D technology utilizes deposited thin-film substrates to which dies are then attached as in MCM-C. There are also variations of these three basic MCM technologies.
- MCM-P multichip plastic quad packs
- MCM-DC ceramic multichip substrate
- MCM-CD multichip plastic quad packs
- the IBM C 4 technology attaches dies to the multichip module in a flip-chip face-down configuration.
- the arrangement minimizes the parasitic inductance of the package leads, and allows pad location at any point on the interior of the die.
- dies are attached to the module using a reflow-solder approach. Dies are bumped by bonding to each pad several layers of protective metalization followed by a 10-200 micron diameter solder ball. A plurality of dies are then accurately positioned on the multichip module, and reflow-soldered into place. Inspection of the solder joints can be done with thermographic or radiographic techniques, but may be difficult otherwise.
- Pad location is no longer limited to the die periphery, but is often constrained by thermal coefficient of expansion mismatch between silicon and module to lie within some radius of the center of the die. Repair is carried out by module heating, die removal, and reflow-soldering of replacement die.
- Chip-first face-up wire-bonding of silicon dies to high density silicon, ceramic, or copper-polyimide modules is similar to conventional hybrid manufacturing technologies, and shares difficulties in rework and bonding yield.
- the GE/TI process forms a planar wafer-like module from collections of selected loose dies placed face down on a flat surface, and then encapsulates it in a polyimide carrier. After curing, this carrier is flipped over, planarized, and used as a module for further (possibly multilayer) metalization.
- the major advantages of metalizing on top of planar ensembles of dies include the fine lithography achievable and very small interconnect parasitics.
- the process can also be generalized to stacks of dies in 3D.
- dies with electrically insulated backs are designed with leads fanned-out to contact pads lined up along an edge, and stacked with those side pads aligned precisely.
- the exposed side is then cleaned and polished, and interconnect lines are metalized onto it.
- the package is extremely dense, although heat dissipation can become limiting, but leads must still travel out to the edge and back to route to other die.
- Off-die signalling designates communicating between two points, on the same die or different dies, using off-die wiring.
- a major design goal with the present art is therefore to increase the number of circuits on each die, increasing the ratio to expensive off-die interconnections.
- the probability that randomly occurring manufacturing defects will produce an unacceptable die rises exponentially in a Poisson distribution. Since slightly larger die yield at significantly lower rates, this so-called “surface-to-volume” (communication-to-computation) ratio severely constrains fabrication yield, hence cost per functioning die.
- Multichip technologies also offer the possibility of reducing the cost of intra-die communication in modern CMOS technologies. If off-die signalling became somewhat less expensive than at present, at some point it would become preferable to on-die wiring for certain intra-die communication. The implications of this need to be recognized by practitioners of today's MCM art: Dies should be made smaller, at the expense of more interconnects per non-communication gate. Smaller dies have significantly higher yield and lower cost per area, so if designers could employ cheap inter-die communication on MCMs, they could transparently treat a multichip module as if it were a single enormous ensemble of electronic devices (including their interconnections), using small, very high yielding monolithic integrated circuit dies (and modules of them) as the subunits. This would be tremendously useful for designers and cost-effective for semiconductor foundries.
- MCMs for intra-die signalling should also have important attractions for low impedance—hence low dispersion-signalling between points on the same die.
- Low dispersion broadcast is essential for clock distribution, and low dispersion point-to-point is useful in general.
- Another application for multichip technologies is in customizing on-die interconnects or engineering change pads. It is valuable to customize interconnects in the manner of a breadboard, within dies up to full wafer-size or among ensembles of dies, in order to rig together specialized functions, test performance, edit out defects, redefine a system's basic connectivity, or perform the functions of engineering change pads.
- customization generally requires a lengthy (circa six week) logic array masking process, unreliable laser fusing/breaking of wiring junctions, significant expense in microfabrication of wiring, macro-scale (e.g., wire-wrap) assemblages, lack of durability (e.g., hand-wired jury-rigs), or a combination of these.
- the enormous value of customization can be exploited with properly designed MCMs.
- MCM Inter-die signalling technology trends demand MCM technology. Shorter signal paths directly contribute to higher performance, since they allow shorter delays and faster clock rates (i.e. more operations per second) and wider synchronous instructions (i.e. more operations per clock tick). Dies are generally planar, so the longest signal path will scale as the diameter, or roughly as the square-root of the area. Planar MCMs can be constructed more densely with smaller dies since they ask less wiring overhead for excursions to the edge and back. In principle, the electronic devices a die bears that make it useful could be disposed volumetrically, but in the current art that is uncommon, except for on-die wiring and stacked capacitors.
- MCMs can in principle be constructed in a space-filling manner, so that the volumetric packing is denser than planar packing, hence signal paths are kept much shorter (e.g., proportional to the cube root of the chip package volume, which is small if the package is thin compared to its area).
- the cost of interconnection networks for signal lines generally scales as a function of area (i.e. a proxy for system real estate) and number of layers (i.e. density and layout efficiency), with linear scaling as a goal.
- area i.e. a proxy for system real estate
- layers i.e. density and layout efficiency
- the number of leads or number of chips within an area may inflate cost by a significant factor in many packaging technologies, such as those using wire-bonds.
- Important advantages to using such hierarchies may include lower cost, modular upgradeability, well-characterized behavior, and multiple sourcing.
- the designer balances competing benefits and costs of a hierarchy: necessarily limiting the degrees of freedom of system design, while commensurately reducing complex system interactions and failure modes.
- Conductive signalling is almost universally understood to be inevitable among practitioners of the present art (See Daryl Ann Doane and Paul D. Franzon, Multichip Module Packaging Technology and Alternatives . Van Nostrand Reinhold, 1993). Conductors in general must expose a face in contact to one another; they cannot hide behind shielding or a passivation layer. If there are (re)movable constituents in the electrical path, there will be exposed surfaces, and unless certain materials (e.g., noble metals) are used on exposed surfaces, conductors may be susceptible to oxidation, although some non-metallic conductors avoid the oxidation problems.
- Troublesome surface chemistry complications include mechanical stability (e.g., whiskering), finite conductance (e.g., charge carrier saturation), and time-dependent material or phase changes (e.g., intermetallic compounds).
- Non-metal conductors have other chemistry problems. If the entire path is bonded continuously, repair and testing may require physically severing material. Removing conductively mated dies, chips or modules for repair/replacement may entail cutting mechanical linkages and removing solder, metal-metal bonds, pins from sockets, or the like. Such breaks introduce metal fatigue (i.e. increase the likelihood of future failure modes) and contamination by conductive dust. The conductor-conductor junctions will later need to be realigned and restored. Intense localized thermal stresses from (de)soldering may also be involved. Methods for replacement pose severe constraints on the design and manufacture of conductively-coupled components in electronic systems.
- Parasitic inductance of 50-1000 pH is typical, and introduces significant latency, frequency limitations, and power requirements for signalling off-chip. While the best currently available MCM technologies reduce the disparity between on-die and off-die communication compared to the conventionally quoted ten-to-one ratio for surface mounted IC technologies, there remain significant penalties associated with inter-die signalling on conventional MCMs. Current MCM technologies suffer from mechanical and thermal problems, design and fabrication limitations, power costs, complexity, and expense.
- pin-substitutes include solder, eutectic, or soft metal (e.g., gold) bumps, conductive wires (e.g., copper, silver, or aluminum) lithographed on polyimide or tape, and sharpened probe needles.
- the circuitry supporting signalling is sensitive to manufacturing variations during wafer fabrication. Manufacturing processes produce variation in basic physical parameters (e.g., impedance, capacitance, inductance) absolutely and spatially, across a wafer or between wafers. This variation causes circuitry to produce waveforms of differing spectra, affecting shape and skew, and differing amplitude, affecting thresholds, noise susceptibility, power requirements and termination characteristics. Unreliable waveform spectra and amplitude means that the yield of dies follows a bell curve distribution, with very few able to operate at higher frequencies. Designers have therefore adopted conservative design rules to compensate for performance ranges.
- basic physical parameters e.g., impedance, capacitance, inductance
- Power must still be provided to the electronic devices in a system, whether the devices are packaged in MCMs or any other level. Nearly all leading MCM designs treat power leads and signal leads the same way at Level 1, which wastes space and loses important opportunities for increasing the density of signal lines.
- One object of the invention relates to a method and apparatus for interconnecting modules which mitigates one or more of the previously identified deficiencies in the prior art.
- Another object of the invention relates to a method and apparatus for coupling signals among modules which mitigates one or more of the previously identified deficiencies in the prior art.
- Another object of the invention relates to a method and apparatus for coupling signals among modules at very high speeds.
- Another object of the invention relates to a method and apparatus for providing improved inter-module and intra-module signal coupling without the need for costly or exotic fabrication techniques.
- Another object of the invention relates to a modular electronic system having shorter signal paths, and to a method for constructing such a system.
- Another object of the invention relates to a modular electronic system wherein at least some of the signals between two dies, between two substrates or between a die and a substrate communicate via capacitive coupling.
- Another object of the invention relates to a modular electronic system wherein at least some of the signals between two dies, between two substrates or between a die and a substrate communicate via magnetic coupling.
- Another object of the invention relates to a modular electronic system wherein a module couples both capacitively and conductively to other modules.
- Another object of the invention relates to a modular electronic system wherein a module couples both magnetically and conductively to other modules.
- Another object of the invention relates to a module adapted to couple capacitively or magnetically to other modules in a modular digital system.
- Another object of the invention relates to a method and apparatus for integrating modules of physically incompatible materials into a modular electronic system wherein signals couple between nearby, physically incompatible modules via capacitive or magnetic means.
- Another object of the invention relates to a method and apparatus for coupling signals between two or more modules without need for additional means to compensate for differences between the chemistry, conducting state, wave phase, fabrication technology, clock rates, voltage levels, numbers of logical states, thermal expansion properties, operating temperature, ambient pressure, or environmental requirements between components.
- Another object of the invention relates to a method and apparatus for coupling signals from or to a superconducting module.
- Another object of the invention relates to a module comprising a plurality of dies formed by several different fabrication technologies, and a method for assembling and testing such a module.
- Another object of the invention relates to a module comprising more technologies or devices than can be supported economically on a single die, and to a method for designing and laying out such a module.
- Another object of the invention relates to a module wherein the connections between dies, or between a die and a substrate, are easily reversible, and to a method for reversibly forming and breaking such connections.
- Another object of the invention relates to a method of repairing or replacing submodules without tearing down interconnection wiring.
- Another object of the invention relates to an MCM wherein neither the process of installing a die nor the process of removing a die damages either the die or a substrate.
- Another object of the invention relates to a method and apparatus for identifying and replacing undesirable modules in a modular electronic system.
- Another object of the invention relates to a method for improving the performance of a modular electronic system by full speed parametric testing of modules within the system.
- Another object of the invention relates to a method for improving the yield of a modular electronic system by full speed testing of modules within the system.
- Another object of the invention relates to a method for improving yield of an MCM by full speed testing of chips and larger modules prior to assembly.
- Another object of the invention relates to a method for improving the performance of a modular electronic system by selective replacement of modules within the system.
- Another object of the invention relates to an MCM comprising a plurality of known-good modules selected by testing in a test fixture having electrical properties substantially identical to those of the MCM substrate.
- Another object of the invention relates to an MCM wherein modules are selectively replaced in order to correct or improve system performance.
- Another object of the invention relates to modules adapted for full speed testing prior to installation in an MCM, and to a method for testing and installing such modules.
- Another object of the invention relates to an MCM wherein modules are attached to a substrate without use of solder or wire-bonding
- Another object of the invention relates to an MCM or other modular digital system wherein a clock signal is distributed with extremely low dispersion, and to a method of distributing clock signals with extremely low dispersion in such systems.
- Another object of the invention relates to an MCM wherein digital signals are communicated among dies via transmission lines on the substrate, the transmission lines being capacitively or magnetically coupled to the dies.
- Another object of the invention relates to an apparatus and method for coupling a transmission line to a means for capacitively signalling, and to a method and apparatus for terminating such couples.
- Another object of the invention relates to a transmission line connected between two means for capacitively signalling and adapted to provide a capacitive path between two separate modules.
- Another object of the invention relates to a method and apparatus for connecting two separate modules capacitively or magnetically by coupled transmission lines.
- Another object of the invention is a modular electronic system having improved signal-to-noise and higher speed transmission of digital signals between modules.
- Another object of the invention relates to a die wherein a substantial number of intra-die connections are routed via off-die signal paths, and a method of designing such a die.
- Another object of the invention is a modular electronic system having improved routing, busing, networking, or switching of signals among constituent modules.
- Another object of the invention relates to methods for laying out modular electronic systems—entailing optimizing interconnections among devices, circuits, blocks, and modules of any size—and to systems so implemented.
- Another object of the invention relates to design of a modular electronic system partitioned into a number of small, high-yielding dies and low cost, high performance inter-die connections.
- Another object of the invention relates to a module wherein the negative effects of misalignments from design, manufacture, assembly, or operation are substantially mitigated, and a method of isolating those effects.
- Another object of the invention relates to a method of designing, manufacturing, assembling, or operating a modular electronic system which removes the need for long-range physical alignment.
- Another object of the invention relates to a method and apparatus for self-aligning a modular electronic system electrically or logically.
- Another object of the invention relates to a method and apparatus for providing low-cost, defect-tolerant wafer-scale interconnections in a modular electronic system.
- Another object of the invention relates to a method for operating a wafer-scale module in spite of fabrication defects.
- Another object of the invention relates to a method and apparatus for reducing the number of packaging hierarchy levels needed for a modular system of a given complexity.
- Another object of the invention relates to a modular electronic system supporting many hierarchical layers of modules.
- Another object of the invention relates to a modular electronic system using standardized interconnections to serve as a building block for larger systems.
- Another object of the invention relates to a method and apparatus for standardizing the assembly of, and the interfaces between, modules in a hierarchical modular electronic system.
- Another object of the invention relates to a method and apparatus for reducing the cost of package engineering and manufacturing for modular electronic systems.
- Another object of the invention relates to a method and apparatus for reducing the turnaround time and cost for breadboarding or prototyping a modular electronic system.
- Another object of the invention relates to a method and apparatus for assembling a modular electronic system from a standardized kit of parts.
- Another object of the invention relates to a method and apparatus for reducing the turnaround time and cost for engineering and manufacturing the package for a modular electronic system.
- Another object of the invention relates to methods for designing, manufacturing, assembling, and operating systems which are faster, lower-powered, cheaper, or have more logical elements, and to systems so implemented.
- Another object of the invention relates to methods for designing, manufacturing, assembling, and operating systems which have preferable packages (e.g., denser, smaller, lighter, tolerant of planar or volumetric constraints), and to systems so implemented.
- preferable packages e.g., denser, smaller, lighter, tolerant of planar or volumetric constraints
- Another object of the invention relates to modular electronic systems with a high density or number of signal interconnections, and to methods for constructing such systems.
- Another object of the invention relates to manufacturing and design methods for scavenging more real estate on wafers for electronic devices than results from methods used in the prior art, and to systems so implemented.
- one aspect of the present invention relates to a modular electronic system comprising at least two modules, at least one of which is powered, and a means for non-conductively (e.g., capacitively or magnetically) communicating between the modules.
- the MCM preferably comprises a substrate having a plurality of dies affixed thereto.
- the means for non-conductively signalling preferably comprises coupled half-capacitors, one half-capacitor plate located on a die and the other located on the substrate or another die, the die and the substrate or other die positioned so as to couple the half-capacitor plates.
- Yet another aspect of the invention relates to a method and apparatus for assembling, testing and repairing modular electronic systems or MCMs based on the non-conductive signalling techniques of the invention.
- Still a further aspect of the invention relates to a modular electronic system or MCM wherein interconnections between elements are non-conductive and, therefore, do not require direct physical contact.
- the modular system or MCM preferably utilizes the flexibility of the non-conductive junctions to accommodate or dissipate thermal stresses within the system.
- a further aspect of the invention relates to a die, chip or module adapted for assembly in a non-conductively interconnected modular system, and including an externally accessible half-capacitor plate and, preferably, a plurality of electronic devices.
- Yet another aspect of the invention relates to an MCM comprising a plurality of heterogeneous elements, each affixed to a substrate and having means for non-conductively coupling signals to transmission lines or wires in the substrate.
- Still other aspects of the invention relate to means for non-conductively signalling between electronic elements and the use of various dielectric, adhesive, elastomeric and other materials in combination therewith.
- Yet another aspect of the invention relates to a method for increasing the manufacturing yield and reducing the cost of a modular electronic system by assembling high yield known-good units to form a modular system utilizing non-conductive interconnections and, if necessary, to repair or optimize the system by replacing selected elements.
- FIG. 1 depicts an exemplary portion of one embodiment of a modular electronic system 1 in accordance with the invention
- FIG. 3 is a partially exploded view of an exemplary portion of a modular electronic system which includes both capacitive and conductive interconnections between a die and a substrate;
- FIG. 4 depicts an exemplary portion of an MCM constructed in accordance with the present invention
- FIG. 8 depicts an illustrative portion of a non-planar modular electronic system that includes multiple dies and substrates;
- FIG. 9 depicts and exemplary portion of a large-scale modular system constructed in accordance with the invention which utilizes a so-called “leapfrog” geometry
- FIG. 10 depicts an illustrative portion of a “leapfrog” integrated system constructed entirely from dies
- FIG. 19 depicts a capacitive signal path including means for adjusting overall gain
- FIG. 22 depicts an exemplary portion of a module electronic system wherein a substrate provides both inter-chip and intra-chip capacitive signal paths;
- FIG. 23B depicts a wafer-scale modular system constructed in accordance with the present invention.
- FIGS. 24-25 compare the fabrication of MCMs in the present art ( FIG. 24 ) and the fabrication of wafer-scale modules in accordance with the invention ( FIG. 25 );
- FIG. 26 depicts the general flow of assembly, testing and rework of a wafer-scale or similar modular system in accordance with the present invention
- FIG. 27 shows the yield of good dies in a typical semiconductor fabrication process as a function die size
- FIG. 28 depicts several plots of system cost as a function of die size for an exemplary capacitively interconnected system
- FIG. 29 depicts the flow of a design cycle for a modular system constructed in accordance with the present invention.
- FIG. 30 depicts a block diagram of an off-die capacitive signal path in accordance with the invention.
- FIGS. 31 A-B depict a final stage of a preferred embodiment of a transmitter
- FIG. 32 depicts a preferred embodiment of a switching means adapted to drive differential capacitive signal paths
- FIG. 33 depicts a simplified electrical model of the interface between an exemplary switching means and a terminated substrate transmission line
- FIG. 34 depicts a simplified electrical model of the interface between an exemplary switching means and an unterminated substrate wiring line
- FIG. 35 depicts a block diagram of a preferred, differential off-die signal path
- FIG. 36 is a schematic diagram of an exemplary single-ended receiver compatible for use in the signal path depicted in FIG. 30 ;
- FIG. 37 is a schematic diagram of an exemplary differential receiver compatible for use in the signal path depicted in FIG. 35 ;
- FIGS. 38 A-B illustrate non-conductive signalling between modules by means of parallel and perpendicular coupled transmission lines.
- system 1 comprises a substrate 10 , a die 11 and a means 13 for capacitively signalling, which provides a capacitive signal path between substrate 10 and die 11 .
- Means 13 for capacitively signalling comprises two electromagnetically communicating regions illustratively depicted as “half-capacitors” 14 and 15 .
- a dielectric 17 is preferably used to partly or totally fill the gap between half-capacitors 14 and 15 .
- Dielectric 17 may be employed to increase the capacitance of capacitive signalling means 13 , to provide passivation for die 11 or substrate 10 , to enhance the thermal conductivity between die 11 and substrate 10 , and/or to mechanically bond or support substrate 10 and die 11 .
- die 11 also illustratively includes a plurality of electronic devices 12 , implemented on an active surface of the die, and a means for powering the die, shown as a conductive contact 16 on the surface of the die.
- Die 11 is preferably a digital integrated circuit fabricated by a conventional, low cost process.
- System 1 preferably includes additional means for capacitively signalling and additional dies, as depicted in later Figures.
- system 1 could comprise an MCM.
- die 11 might be a CMOS silicon die with active components 12 fabricated on its surface, while the substrate 10 might be a die fabricated of GaAs.
- capacitive signalling means 13 offers considerable advantages over conventional alternative approaches.
- Conventional approaches such as packaging the dies independently and wiring them together conductively, or growing a crystal of one material on a region of the other, are significantly more expensive for comparable performance than comparable systems constructed in accordance with the present invention.
- such conventional systems generally suffer low yields and low operational reliability, due to thermal expansion stresses.
- Die 11 preferably includes one or more conductive contacts 16 for powering the devices 12 .
- contact 16 illustratively is a metallic aluminum region fabricated lithographically on the silicon CMOS die. In some applications, it may be desirable to gold-plate the outer surface of the aluminum region to protect against corrosion.
- power could be delivered by means of a metallic fuzz button conductively connected to substrate 10 or to a different substrate. Fuzz button power connections, in combination with coupled half-capacitor signal connections 14 and 15 , allow die 11 to be successively mounted and removed from substrate 10 non-destructively, which affords significant advantages in terms of testing, repair or performance optimization, as compared to destructive approaches. Such non-destructive mount/remove cycles entail substantially zero forces, torques, or changes in energy across the means 13 for capacitive signalling.
- Substrate 10 is preferably constructed from a low dielectric factor material in order to facilitate high speed signalling.
- the substrate can be either passive or active.
- An example of a passive substrate is a printed wiring board wherein half-capacitor 15 would preferably comprise a lithographically defined copper region of substrate 10 .
- An example of an active substrate is a collection of active and/or passive semiconductor devices and wiring. Typical active elements are set forth below.
- Superconducting substrates are particularly well-suited to use coupled half-capacitors, due to the absence of any metallic contact between die 11 and the superconducting substrate 10 .
- Materials problems which might otherwise arise in soldering or bonding to brittle high temperature superconducting ceramic layers are eliminated. All of the propagation advantages of superconducting transmission lines (especially low dispersion) are retained.
- termination resistor fabrication is potentially challenging, this can be done with localized heating of a line above the transition temperature, or by application of sufficiently intense DC magnetic fields to force the superconductor normal in the resistive region.
- Such techniques may also provide a means for tuning the value of the termination resistance in a post-fabrication step by adjusting the current which heats or induces the magnetic field.
- half-capacitors 14 and 15 comprise conductive plates.
- Die half-capacitor 14 may comprise an aluminum metal pad lithographically defined on a CMOS silicon integrated circuit 11 .
- Adequate capacitance can be realized using the upper level of the integrated circuit die metalization to form half-capacitor 14 , and a matching plate on a high density substrate 10 as the other half-capacitor 15 .
- Coupled half-capacitors can be formed in arrangements, like 13 , which couple one-to-one, or alternatively in structures which couple one-to-many or many-to-many.
- the circuitry for sending and receiving signals via coupled half-capacitors can advantageously fit underneath or beside the corresponding half-capacitor; the plates themselves therefore need not be lithographed at the expense of usable chip real estate.
- the invention provides significant advantages in terms of the area required to implement high performance inter-die signalling circuits.
- Coupled half-capacitors are preferably formed by affixing die 11 to substrate 10 such that half-capacitors 14 and 15 effectively overlap.
- use of coupled half-capacitors instead of conventional chips first, soldered, or wire-bonded connections substantially relaxes the need for high precision alignment.
- the size or shape of half-capacitors 14 and 15 need not be identical, and can be advantageously optimized to mitigate the effects of anticipated misalignments, such as those from manufacturing tolerances, assembly errors, or thermal mismatch.
- Circuitry for coupled half-capacitors can cost substantially less chip real estate per bit than connections for conductively coupled off-die signalling.
- the driver and receiver circuits are small enough to be fabricated underneath the corresponding half-capacitor plate.
- the plates are smaller than contact pads and fan-out leads in the present art, and can overlay other active circuitry, including circuitry unrelated to I/O. Plates can be packed much more densely than pads, and can occupy any part of the surface of the die rather than predominantly the perimeter.
- Alternative dielectric materials such as oriented barium titanate crystals which have a dielectric factor more than 100 times larger than titanium dioxide, may further increase the I/O density.
- the half-capacitor plate size becomes smaller than the driver/receiver circuitry, and the die is circuit-limited rather than I/O pad-limited, there is little point in further reducing the size of the plate except in certain scenarios: where they comprise multiple platelet regions ganged together electrically and logically; where they are used for AC powering; or where other surface accessible functions like optical transmitters/detectors compete for surface space.
- Standard semiconductor processes allow active circuitry to be implemented beneath a metal half-capacitor plate.
- implementation of active circuitry beneath conductive contact pads is undesirable because mechanical forces imposed on the contact pad can irreversibly alter the electronic behavior of the underlying domain.
- Half-capacitors 14 and 15 need not be constructed of the same material and can even be formed from chemically incompatible materials.
- the half-capacitors can be formed by any means from any uniform or composite material(s)—including metals, superconductors (including High T c ), semi-conductors, semi-metals, impedance-varying or conductance-varying materials—in single or multiple layers or domains. They can be built in any state or form of matter-including gases, gasified material, liquids, liquified material, solids, solidified material, composite, slurry, gel, suspension, matrix, or others.
- the inter-plate gap between half-capacitors 14 and 15 may be filled with a high dielectric material or left empty (with air or vacuum).
- the dielectric 17 is a high dielectric factor fluid, such as ethylene glycol.
- Dielectric 17 can be disposed between a series of passivation layers on each plate, if any, and intervening insulator, if any. Such passivation layers can be formed cheaply and reliably from oxides of the metalization layer and/or from applied emulsion coatings such as titanium dioxide, crystalline barium titanate oriented along the high-dielectric axis, and other materials which are well-known in the electrochemical community and commercially available.
- the known corrosion properties, cleanliness, and viscosity as a function of temperature of the dielectric are crucial, as is its dielectric factor.
- Colloidal suspensions of high dielectric factor solids e.g., ceramics like titanium dioxide applied in a slurry
- the dielectric may be an insulating liquid, such as, ethylene glycol, propylene glycol, glycerin, or nitrobenzene; a gas, such as uranium hexafluoride; or a mixed-phase suspension or gel, in order to exploit heat transport properties, cleanliness, or mechanical stability.
- Liquid dielectrics may be useful in certain systems, in part because no sheer force is transmitted if the chips have to be moved, and in part because the dielectric is scratch proof. Spacers on the chip surface could assure constant separation in the presence of a high dielectric liquid like glycerol but are not required unless shorting is a risk. In the case of liquid dielectrics, surface tension may be sufficient to hold the die and substrate against one another.
- Intervening insulator(s) should generally slide on at least one side to accommodate thermal expansion, and may either be bonded to one of the dies, substrates or modules, as with an adhesive, or maintained as a monolithic material bonded to neither, such as Cellophane. Bonding to both surfaces should be avoided, except with liquid dielectrics, elastomers, or systems carefully engineered to accommodate thermal expansion.
- Dielectrics may also be engineered to enable/disable capacitance above a threshold between paired half-capacitors.
- Extremely low cost processes from the painting/copying industry e.g., lithography are well-known for fabricating printed wiring boards, and can analogously be employed to implement the dielectric pattern, effectively defining interconnections.
- multi-storey capacitively coupled structures can be constructed wherein one or more intervening conductive regions are disposed (preferably in the dielectric region) between two terminal half-capacitors, thereby effectively forming a series connected chain of two or more capacitors.
- such multi-layer structures do not require any overlap between the two terminal half-capacitors.
- overlap only between the bottom plate and a middle conductor and between the top plate and the middle conductor suffices to implement a means for capacitively signalling between the top and bottom plates.
- Printing/copying processes e.g., xerography
- FIG. 2 depicts an exemplary portion of a modular electronic system wherein a signal is differentially coupled from a pair of transmission lines 32 and 33 on substrate 10 , across a pair of coupled half-capacitors 13 , to a pair of transmission lines 34 and 37 on die 10 .
- a means for terminating transmission lines 32 and 33 is provided on substrate 10 by termination resistors 31 b and 31 c , connected to a ground plane by line 31 a.
- transmission lines 34 and 37 connect to on-die driver and/or receiver circuits, implemented as some of the active elements 12 of die 11 .
- Transmission lines 32 and 33 may couple to driver or receiver circuits implemented on substrate 10 , to other chips, modules or substrates via additional coupled half-capacitors, or to external conductive leads.
- Transmission lines 32 and 33 are preferably implemented as microstrip, stripline or slotline transmission lines. Of course, ordinary unterminated metal or polysilicon interconnect will suffice in certain applications.
- FIG. 3 shows a partially exploded view of an exemplary portion of a modular electronic system which includes both capacitive and conductive interconnections between die 11 and substrate 10 .
- Conductive contact pads 45 , 46 and 47 illustratively receive power, ground and a plurality of I/O signals from substrate 10 .
- Conductive connection is achieved by affixing die 11 to substrate 10 such that conductive connection means 41 , 42 and 43 touch their respective contacts 45 , 46 and 47 .
- this permits non-destructive removal of die 11 from substrate 10 , thereby providing substantial fabrication, testing and repair advantages for modular systems based on the present invention.
- Conductive connection means preferably comprise metallic fuzz buttons, such as the CinapseTM contacts manufactured by Cinch, Inc.
- the holes in substrate 10 which accommodate metallic fuzz buttons 41 , 42 , 43 are preferably conically tapered to ensure that the buttons do not interfere with seating of die 11 against substrate 10 .
- Alternative conductive means include solder balls, wiring on tape or films, bonded wires, contact probes, liquid metals such as mercury, low melting point metals such as gallium, and other high conductance media such as may be appropriate for particular engineering situations.
- the conductive connections can be customized by impairing (e.g., removing, eroding or destroying) or adding selected fuzz-buttons, thereby disabling or enabling conductive connection between the selected fuzz-buttons and their respective contact pads.
- the conductive connections 45 , 46 , 47 can be much larger than the capacitive couplings, since power feeds are rarer than signal feeds and benefit from the lessened resistance of bigger leads.
- Conductive contacts are however relatively very expensive and failure prone compared to coupled half-capacitors. It is therefore advantageous to employ the relatively coarse technology of conductive contacts only for DC power leads, while retaining the invention's advantages of many high bandwidth capacitively coupled paths for signalling.
- Contact pads for fuzz buttons occupy 0.3 mm 2 each in the preferred embodiment.
- circuitry to drive the capacitive couplings occupies about 0.04 mm 2 per half-capacitor, based on a 1 micron CMOS process.
- Multiply-redundant contact pads may advantageously compensate for the relatively low reliability of mechanical contacts.
- FIG. 4 depicts an exemplary portion of an MCM constructed in accordance with the present invention.
- the MCM comprises a substrate 10 , a first die 11 and a second die 61 .
- First die 11 and second die 61 could also represent different parts of a single die.
- a terminated transmission line 33 interconnects half-capacitors 15 and 65 on substrate 10 , thereby providing a signal path between half-capacitor 14 on the first die 11 and half-capacitor 64 on the second die 61 .
- Transmission line 33 provides efficient communication between half-capacitors 65 and 15 .
- the power required to couple a signal from half-capacitor 64 (on second die 61 ) to half-capacitor 14 (on first die 11 ), via transmission line 33 is substantially independent of the length 51 of transmission line 33 .
- the off-die route offers potentially superior performance to an equivalent on-die routing of the same signal.
- the off-die coupling of signals via the substrate involves substantial performance penalties due to the excessive parasitic inductance of the conductive die/substrate connections.
- First die 11 and second die 61 also include conductive contact pads 52 for, among other things, receiving power from substrate 10 .
- dies 11 and 61 can be formed from different or incompatible materials.
- first die 11 could comprise a low cost CMOS integrated circuit while second die 61 could comprise a GaAs integrated circuit, including optical I/O devices.
- the spacings 50 and 60 between the dies and substrate can be the same or different, as needed to accommodate the electronic or physical requirements of dies 11 and 61 .
- similar or different dielectrics 17 and 67 can be used in the half-capacitors that couple dies 11 and 61 , respectively, to substrate 10 .
- the tolerance of the capacitive interconnections to thermal expansion represents an important advantage of the invention over conventional MCMs.
- dies 11 and 61 represent different portions of a large (e.g., wafer-scale) die
- the misalignment errors due to thermal expansion mismatch accrue and can become particularly troublesome.
- thermal expansion problems often require that the substrate material be selected to match, as closely as possible, the thermal expansion properties of a particular die material, typically silicon.
- the present invention permits integration of heterogeneous dies or modules on a common substrate with substantially relaxed thermal expansion constraints, at least for dies of modest size.
- half-capacitor 65 is advantageously sized larger than half-capacitor 64 .
- FIG. 5 depicts an exemplary portion of an MCM similar to that of FIG. 4 , but including a power substrate 70 , distinct from the signal substrate 10 , as well as a heat sink 81 .
- Power substrate 70 preferably includes a ground plane 74 , power plane 75 and decoupling capacitance 79 coupling therebetween.
- a plurality of terminals represented as elements 76 , 77 and 78 on power substrate 70 are conductively connected to respective terminals on die 11 and provide ground, power and a plurality of external I/O leads, respectively, to die 11 .
- Ground plane 74 , power plane 75 and the power/ground wiring associated therewith are preferably fabricated using a low resolution lithographic process.
- Power substrate 70 might alternatively be formed from materials, such as metals, ceramics, organic polymers, silicon, inorganic polymers, glasses, amorphous solids, crystalline solids, polycrystalline solids, composite materials, heterogeneous multilayer materials, or others.
- Power substrate 70 may be made of rigid or flexible material, depending upon the application, and may include holes or similar patterned features to accommodate, for example, an external optical I/O path 83 from/to an optical I/O device 82 on chip 85 .
- external power, ground and I/O terminals 71 , 72 and 73 on power substrate 70 can be wire-bonded to appropriately configured pins or other external leads, thereby providing a conventional Level 1, 11 ⁇ 2, 2, or 3 package lead-out as appropriate.
- the conductive connections between terminals 71 , 72 and 73 on power substrate 70 and similar terminals on chip 11 can be fabricated by reflow-solder, liquid metal or other conductor, metallic fuzz buttons, pin & socket, other mechanically compliant reversible or irreversible contacts, or by wire-bond or other welding techniques.
- power could be provided to die 11 or other dies using integrated batteries or high frequency alternating current instead of direct current, thereby dispensing with any requirement for conductively coupled contact points altogether.
- Use of optical or near-optical frequencies to couple power is preferable since it increases transmission efficiency, and polarizing the radiation decreases crosstalk interference with other signal interconnections, notably including on-chip circuitry.
- essentially all of a die's surface, except that employed for I/O e.g., signal coupling half-capacitors, semiconductor lasers, photodetectors and the like), can be used to receive power.
- FIG. 5 also depicts a means for dissipating heat from dies 11 and 85 comprising a heat sink 81 and a thermal elastomer 80 positioned between heat sink 81 and dies 11 and 85 .
- Thermal elastomer 80 preferably comprises a material having high thermal conductivity, such as organic elastomers filled with boron nitride.
- other known methods for effecting good thermal contact between dies 11 and 85 and heat sink 81 can be used, including maintaining the dies and heat sink in intimate physical contact, employing thermally conductive greases or epoxies, soldering or eutectic bonding of the heat sink and dies, and the like.
- thermal elastomer is an electrical insulator or conductor, unless dies operating at different bulk potentials share the same heat sink. But for this or other reasons an electrical insulator may be preferred. Ceramic loaded elastomers containing aluminum oxide or (preferably) boron nitride are one such approach.
- Heat sink 81 can be cooled with any standard cooling technique, including conductive, convective, or radiative transfer, or by phase change of a suitable material, as in a heat pipe.
- heat sink 81 also comprises a pressure plate 84 .
- Force 84 applied through pressure plate 81 assures intimate contact between dies 11 and 85 and substrates 10 and 70 , as well as dies 11 and 85 and heat sink 81 .
- Positioning the dies and substrates relative to one another by means of pressure offers important advantages with respect to building and unbuilding the MCM assembly reversibly (e.g., for repair, inspection, testing, performance enhancement, and so forth).
- use of a reformable elastomer 80 further contributes to these reversibility advantages.
- thermal expansion should be matched.
- this constraint is no different from that faced in conventional MCM designs, which commonly employ distinct power and signal substrates. Accordingly, appropriate techniques for matching or compensating for the thermal expansions of substrates 10 and 70 are known to those ordinarily skilled in the art.
- the signal lines in substrate 10 may advantageously be fabricated as microstrips, striplines or slotlines. In general, more layers will be required on substrate 10 as the size of substrate 10 (and the number of or size of die(s)) grows to compensate for the typical geometric increase in wire density.
- the superior electrical characteristics of the lithographically formed transmission lines on substrate 10 allows use of longer-than-minimal routing paths in order to relieve layout wiring congestion. Assuming that the resistors terminating a transmission line are lithographically fabricated, the cost of manufacturing substrate 10 is approximately linear as a function of area or at worst is a slowly growing geometric function.
- the manufacturing cost is not proportional to the number of signal interconnections between substrate and die(s), as is the case for the many conventional contact junctions needed for conductive signalling.
- the cost of the remaining components-power substrate 70 , heat sink 81 , pressure plate 84 , and thermal elastomer layer 80 scale approximately linearly with area, also independent of the number of die/substrate signal interconnections.
- FIG. 5 also shows two exemplary passivation layer configurations for dies 11 and 85 .
- Passivation layer 86 (covering die 11 ) and layer 87 (covering die 85 ) are preferably thin, protective layers of silicon dioxide, silicon nitride, polyimide, borosilicate glass or similar materials.
- passivation layer 87 covers the entire active surface of die 85 , while passivation layer 86 is patterned and does not cover half-capacitor plate 14 .
- Common passivation materials have significantly lower dielectric factors than many of the materials contemplated for use in the preferred embodiment of dielectric 17 . Accordingly, the passivation materials preferably should not be used on the half-capacitor plates and, if used, should have as high dielectric factors as practical.
- Passivation layer 86 is patterned by lithographically defining regions of the passivation layer to be removed during the chip fabrication process, then selectively removing such regions.
- the lithographically defined region can be smaller than the half-capacitor plate, so as to provide a border region surrounding the half-capacitor wherein the passivation layer partially overlaps the plate. With only a portion of the half-capacitor plate 14 exposed without passivation, the influx of chemical contaminants is effectively discouraged.
- passivation layer 87 covers half-capacitor plate 64 . This approach typically reduces the available capacitance of the coupled half-capacitors, but eliminates possible contamination problems at the exposed plate boundary.
- the conductive contacts 52 will be unpassivated, as in current fabrication technologies.
- noble metal contacts may be useful for avoiding oxidation or corrosion.
- FIG. 5 also illustrates why manufacturing and construction of a modular system in accordance with the invention is simpler than current techniques for forming a modular system with a comparable number of signal interconnections and similar density.
- the exemplary fabrication of half-capacitor plates and passivation layers employs standard semiconductor fabrication techniques, and the dielectric can itself be the adhesive holding the modular system together, while the heat sink and thermal elastomer are largely standard components.
- the substrate (and power substrate, if employed) can be easily mass-produced with current techniques. While some changes will be required in the CAD layout tools, the flexibility to locate half-capacitor interconnect plates directly above other signal lines on the dies simplifies the layout problem.
- Fuzz buttons are comparable to pressed gold wires and TAB in assuring reliable electrical contact, although neither is as mechanically robust as solder or a lithographed metal junction. Fuzz buttons are at present, however, the easiest and most reliable of those conductive contact means to handle through repair/replacement cycles.
- the plurality of means for capacitively signalling avoids, by design, significant amounts of thermally induced sheer stress, assuming the dielectric is properly selected. In any case, the heat stress and forces perpendicular to the surface will likely be significantly lower than in conventional modular systems in which conductive bonds are pushed or soldered together.
- Using capacitive couplings for signalling means that many fewer conductive contacts are needed (e.g., only for power, ground, or off-module I/O). Therefore, the Poisson statistics for anticipating failure need only account for a fraction of the number of mechanical components, as compared to conductively coupled signalling systems.
- important failure modes in MCM-level modular systems include solder deformities, electromigration, and metal-metal corrosion.
- Typical processes for assembling MCMs involve repeated installation and removal of dies from the module. During these steps, failure modes associated with the conductive connections to dies represent the dominant factor diminishing the yield or reliability of the manufacturing process. Such yield loss correlates strongly with the number of conductive connections. Therefore, the present invention, which employs dramatically fewer conductive connections than conventional MCM technologies, enjoys considerable advantages in terms of manufacturing/assembling yield, reliability, reparability and cost. These simplifications also benefit the design and operating cycles.
- FIGS. 6 A-D depict exemplary waveforms for a 3-state digital signal coupled from die 11 to die 85 of FIG. 5 and appropriately supported by 3-state logic.
- FIG. 6A shows a typical digital waveform in a high speed digital system.
- the waveform consists of a series of states, the states being defined by the level of the waveform during a particular clock period 29 .
- the waveform represents a digital “1”.
- the waveform during period 23 represents a state designated “ ⁇ 1”.
- the waveform is generated by a digital circuit constructed from devices 12 on die 11 .
- a transmitter circuit on die 11 converts the digital waveform of FIG. 6A into a pulsed waveform as depicted in FIG. 6B .
- the 3-state transmitter suppresses the trailing edge transition, which a 2-state (binary) transmitter advantageously would not bother doing.
- the exemplary pulsed waveform generated by the transmitter includes a pulse 24 representing the logic state during a particular portion of the clock period.
- the pulsed waveform is applied to half-capacitor 14 , from which it travels to half-capacitor 64 by way of a first half-capacitor 15 , terminated transmission line 33 , and second half-capacitor 65 on substrate 10 .
- FIG. 6C shows the pulsed waveform received on half-capacitor 64 , lagged in time due to the finite speed of transmission over the electrical distance from half-capacitor 14 , and attenuated by the non-zero series impedance of the electrical path.
- the transmission of pulsed waveforms between half-capacitor plates 14 and 64 achieves much better signal-to-noise ratio than would a conventional conductive interconnection operating at the same power.
- the signal received by half-capacitor 64 is coupled to a receiver circuit on die 85 .
- This receiver circuit generates the digital output signal depicted in FIG. 6D .
- the 3-state receiver has timing circuitry or access to a clock signal, so can discern and restore “0” states 22 as well as the trailing edges suppressed by the transmitter.
- the waveform of FIG. 6D represents a delayed and restored version of the original digital input waveform depicted in FIG. 6A .
- FIGS. 6 A-D are merely exemplary.
- a myriad of signalling schemes are possible, many of which are preferred over the simple, un-encoded, 3-state single-ended scheme depicted in FIGS. 6 A-D.
- differential binary signalling offers significant advantages in terms of noise immunity.
- the signalling across coupled half-capacitors need not utilize the pulsed digital mode depicted in FIGS. 6 A-D, but can instead employ any modulation of some combination of phase, frequency, amplitude and/or signal-to-noise ratio.
- the signals can have any form that does not require coupling of the DC component across the coupled half-capacitor.
- the signals may comprise binary or multistate codings, and, in the case of a ganged half-capacitor junction, may represent a multibit encoding encompassing the signals from one or more half-capacitors as channels.
- the presently preferred embodiment employs pulses, each representing a bit, which are sent across a “differential pair” of coupled half-capacitor junctions. This is essentially a binary differential version of the technique illustrated in FIGS. 6 A-D.
- Many of the telecommunication industry's techniques for communicating digital information over bandwidth-limited communication links have no DC component, and thus are advantageous in connection with the present invention. Notable such methods include alternate mark inverse and 10 B 8 codes.
- any coding scheme based on (approximately) constant numbers of zero & one bits, such as Knuth's methods, will have particularly advantageous signal-to-noise properties for a given power budget.
- Modem techniques designed for limited bandwidth environments including frequency key shifting, phase encoding, and amplitude coding, are also useful as are hybrid coding schemes, such as QPSK.
- Multidimensional sphere packing, Reed-Solomon codes, Trellis codes, or other algorithms for coding states across one or more signal channels can be used to maximize inter-chip signalling bandwidth, up to the Shannon limit for the system, which may be higher than the clock rate.
- the class of coding schemes with limited bandwidth since they can be used to transmit signals through exponentially tapered stripline transmission line transformers, allowing the matching of signals with high voltage swing but low current to low impedance transmission lines as part of the coupled half-capacitor Limiting the bandwidth can advantageously avoid difficulties arising from dispersive lines.
- Major causes of such dispersion include the frequency-dependence of the line's dielectric factor, frequency dependent dielectric losses, skin effect and losses from the source resistance.
- Bridging die 89 includes at least two half-capacitors 14 a - b , each of which couples to half-capacitors 15 a - b on different substrates 10 a - b via dielectrics 17 a - b .
- Bridging die 89 preferably includes a plurality of active electronic devices implemented on an active surface 12 thereof.
- Substrates 10 a and 10 b may be of similar or dissimilar construction.
- half-capacitors 14 a - b and 15 a - b are advantageously sized to accommodate anticipated thermal expansion and/or mechanical misalignment.
- Either a passive or active signal path on bridging die 89 connects half-capacitors 14 a and 14 b .
- an active signal path may be used to convert between incompatible signal waveforms, timings and/or codings on substrates 10 a and 10 b.
- Bridging die 89 preferably comprises a part of a very large system wherein a multiplicity of substrates are tied together with bridging modules, in this example a die.
- Systems formed from a multiplicity of substrates bearing microelectronic devices and/or wiring need not be primarily planar like those depicted in FIGS. 5 and 7 , and can be extremely large: Barn Door Scale Integration is possible using the invention.
- FIGS. 9, 10 , and 13 extend the teaching to exemplary extensible non-planar and planar arrangements.
- Buckling modes may arise at the edges overlapped by bridging modules, particularly in vibration-rich environments. Such bending or expansion modes may effectively limit the diameter of buildable systems. Fortunately, these issues are well-understood by practitioners, and can be ameliorated in the preferred embodiment by a combination of compliant, mechanically damping dielectric or mounting materials, and use of compensatingly larger half-capacitors and circuit thresholds near the affected regions.
- FIG. 8 depicts an illustrative portion of a modular electronic system that includes multiple dies 11 , 92 , 95 and substrates 10 , 90 , 93 .
- die 11 is capacitively coupled to substrate 10 .
- the multi-storey structure of the capacitive signal path coupling chip 11 to substrate 10 (by way of conductor 14 y , illustratively depicted as having been fabricated monolithically amidst dielectrics 17 x and 17 y ) creates an “effective overlap” between half-capacitors 14 x and 15 x , which are not “substantially overlapped” plates.
- Substantially overlapped half-capacitors, such as 94 a and 15 are effectively overlapped ipso facto.
- Substrate 10 is also capacitively coupled to substrate 90 .
- wiring 91 connects a plurality of half-compactiors 94 a to a plurality of half-capacitors 94 b , thereby providing an AC signal path between substrate 10 and substrate 93 and between substrate 10 and die 92 .
- Substrate 93 also connects conductively to die 95 via a plurality of conductive leads 97 , bonded to a plurality of conductive pads 96 on substrate 93 .
- substrate 10 may comprise a printed wiring board, while substrate 90 may comprise a multilayer ceramic substrate.
- Substrate 93 may be encapsulated within a plastic carrier package 98 , which package also advantageously encapsulates die 95 .
- Modules 92 and 11 may represent separate dies or different portions of the same die or wafer.
- Flexible or articulated substrates may be used to further extend the number of feasible physical arrangements. Abutting or partially overlapping substrates may be used to couple signals, clocks, etc. throughout a large system, as in FIGS. 9-10 .
- FIG. 9 depicts an exemplary portion of a large-scale modular system constructed in accordance with the invention.
- FIG. 9 illustrates a so-called “leapfrog” geometry: Signals “leap” from a first module to a second via a bridging module which partially overlaps the first and second modules. Using this leapfrog assembly technique, large-scale systems can be constructed very economically.
- a portion of die 115 overlaps substrate 123 such that half-capacitors 111 and 113 align to provide a capacitive signal path between substrate 123 and die 115 .
- the leapfrog arrangement continues with substrate 124 , which partially overlaps and capacitively couples to die 115 via coupled half-capacitors 125 and 116 .
- substrate 140 partially overlaps and capacitively couples with substrate 124 , thus extending the leapfrog configuration.
- the leapfrog technique can also be used to distribute power from one die/substrate to the next through, for example, the previously mentioned fuzz-button connections.
- non-bridging die 119 (not part of the leapfrog arrangement) having a plurality of active devices and coupled to substrate 124 via a plurality of coupled half-capacitors 117 .
- non-bridging die 136 illustratively employs an off-die signal path (in substrate 140 ) to couple circuits on active surface 138 proximate to half-capacitors 133 and 135 .
- the top level modules 123 , 124 and 136 can be individually replaced, if defective, without further disassembly of the system. Even replacement of the bottom modules 115 , 119 and 140 requires relatively little disassembly in a system having a large number of modules.
- Still another advantage of the leapfrog configuration is the high performance of its inter-die connections.
- coupled half-capacitors or coupled transmission lines
- the lengths of signal paths will be shorter than, for example, conventional technologies which utilize peripherally distributed pins, such as PC boards or MCMs with surface mounted dies.
- the combination of shorter signal paths and lower parasitic inductances can lead to a substantial increase in overall system performance.
- a clock signal can be broadcast, preferably from a centrally located module in a leapfrog integrated system, via a plurality of clock distribution paths, each of which comprises one or more transmission line segments linked by coupled half-capacitors.
- Such clock distribution paths preferably do not include restoring logic (e.g., transmitter and/or receiver circuits) and thus avoid introducing unnecessary gate delays into the clock signal.
- the leapfrog configuration of the present invention reduces the lengths of signal paths, which provides a linear improvement in signal propagation time. Accordingly, low latency can be achieved using the invention without need for exotic, low dielectric factor substrates.
- a further advantage of the leapfrog configuration is that it enables integration of heterogeneous, incompatible modules.
- the voltage levels, materials, etc. can be different among semiconductor die 115 , die 119 , and die 136 , thereby permitting a system designer to exploit the particular advantages of various technologies within a densely integrated system.
- the properties of substrates 123 , 124 and 140 can be selected to enhance performance, reliability, reparability, cost, and other factors.
- die 115 might be consumer-grade silicon CMOS
- die 119 might bear microelectronic devices on diamond
- die 136 might be a high-temperature superconducting material bearing Josephson Junctions
- substrate 123 might be a laminate material such as FR4
- substrate 124 might be an active substrate formed with a thin-film such as lines lithographed onto a chips-first plane
- substrate 140 might be a thick-film fabricated xerographically.
- components which a capacitively coupled multichip system might carry include logic devices (e.g., Field Programmable Logic Arrays), (field-programmable) gate arrays, processors, arithmetic units, bitwise manipulation units (e.g., cellular automata), permutation units, interconnection networks, memory, nanomechanical actuators, sensors, arrays of fractional analog or digital components (e.g., resistors of various sizes), or others.
- logic devices e.g., Field Programmable Logic Arrays
- field-programmable gate arrays e.g., field-programmable gate arrays
- processors e.g., arithmetic units, bitwise manipulation units (e.g., cellular automata), permutation units, interconnection networks, memory, nanomechanical actuators, sensors, arrays of fractional analog or digital components (e.g., resistors of various sizes), or others.
- bitwise manipulation units e.g., cellular automata
- permutation units e.g., interconnection
- FIG. 10 depicts an illustrative portion of a leapfrog integrated system constructed entirely from dies.
- replacement of substrates 123 , 124 and 140 (of FIG. 9 ) with dies 163 , 164 and 180 permits denser integration of logic and other circuits, as well as perfect matching of thermal coefficients of expansion.
- the properties and advantages of the FIG. 10 die-die-die leapfrog configuration are analogous to those of the FIG. 9 die-substrate-die leapfrog assembly or FIG. 7 substrate-die-substrate assembly, and therefore need not be reiterated.
- Power is advantageously delivered through the interstices between dies in such a system, rather than through either perforations or diffused contacts through dies, and may advantageously employ a dedicated power substrate and pressure plate.
- FIGS. 11 a - b depict the effect of misalignment between capacitor plates in a capacitively coupled modular system.
- FIG. 11 a shows a portion of a capacitively coupled system wherein dies 251 , 252 , 253 and 254 are perfectly aligned so as to define overlapping regions 255 , 256 and 257 identical to the size of the half-capacitor plates. In this idealized configuration, capacitive signal coupling is maximized and unwanted crosstalk is minimized.
- FIG. 11 b shows the same portion wherein die 252 (of FIG. 11 a ) has been replaced by a misaligned die 262 .
- the misalignment of die 262 decreases the area of regions 265 and 256 which represent overlap of the misaligned die's half-capacitors. Therefore, the magnitude of the signal coupled between die 262 and dies 251 and 253 will diminish; crosstalk between die 262 's half-capacitors and other proximate conductive signal lines or half-capacitors may increase as well.
- the misalignment of die 262 does not affect the coupling or alignment between other dies not directly coupled to 262 , for example, die 254 .
- the size of the half-capacitors associated with those particular dies can be advantageously increased to compensate.
- only those particular half-capacitors associated with the troublesome dies need be enlarged. Therefore, there is no significant decrease in the overall density of off-die connections in the system.
- the low cost or inherent tolerance to misalignment of coupled half-capacitor junctions makes these junctions useful in many different applications, not just in multichip modules.
- cables utilizing half-capacitor connections potentially provide cost, reliability, size and performance advantages over conventional cables (See FIG. 21 ).
- high pin-count modular consumer products, such as dockable laptop computers will realize similar benefits by use of the invention.
- Pad-limited chips in general can advantageously be implemented using the invention. Notable such chips typically compose signal routing networks, binary integrated circuits whose size is limited by the number of permissible simultaneous 1-0 or 0-1 transitions, and many very small chips.
- FIGS. 12 a - b depict the use of an oversized half-capacitor plate to minimize the impact of misalignment.
- half-capacitor 272 is intentionally made larger than half-capacitor 273 . This allows die 274 to expand substantially (as depicted in FIG. 12 b ) without affecting the area of half-capacitor plate overlap (i.e. 270 versus 271 ).
- Another use for an oversized half-capacitor plate such as 272 is to terminate some of the fringing field lines from the smaller half-capacitor plate 273 which would otherwise terminate on other nearby structures. This advantageously reduces the amount of crosstalk received by the smaller half-capacitor plate 273 .
- FIG. 13 depicts an exemplary portion of a heterogeneously integrated system and illustrates various techniques for integrating modules in accordance with the invention.
- the system of FIG. 13 illustratively depicts two hierarchical levels arranged in a substantially space-filling package.
- the integration techniques exemplified therein are extensible systems utilizing deeper levels of hierarchical encapsulation in 2D or 3D.
- the system comprises modules 200 , 211 and 219 .
- Module 200 comprises capacitively coupled chips 201 and 204 .
- Module 211 comprises capacitively coupled chips 208 and 210 .
- Module 219 comprises capacitively coupled chips 215 and 219 a.
- FIG. 13 exemplifies a variety of means for coupling modules 200 , 211 and 219 in accordance with the invention.
- Cable 214 conductively couples chip 204 of module 200 to chip 208 of module 211 .
- a capacitive signal path is provided between chip 202 of module 200 and chip 210 of module 211 via half-capacitor 203 , half-capacitor 205 , interconnection substrate 206 , half-capacitor 207 and half-capacitor 209 .
- the mounting of chips 215 and 219 a in module 219 is angled against a spacer 212 to accommodate an illustratively depicted externally imposed form factor requirement.
- Flexible interconnection substrate 216 completes a capacitive signal path 217 between chip 208 of module 211 and chip 215 of module 219 , and is preferably fabricated from a flexible material so as to accommodate non-planer form factor constraints.
- Chip 215 of module 219 receives further input from external conductive or optical connection 218 .
- FIG. 13 makes up a substantially space filling assembly.
- the space filling assembly depicted on FIG. 13 may itself be a modular part of a larger modular electronic system.
- Systems implemented in volumetrically dense 3D space filling packages generally have shorter average path lengths and faster clock rates than 2D implementations.
- Heat sinks are not explicitly shown in FIG. 13 , but may be easily positioned as disclosed elsewhere herein.
- Spacer 212 in addition to providing mechanical support to meet externally imposed form factor requirements, also advantageously conducts heat away from chips 210 and 219 a.
- FIG. 14 depicts an embodiment of the invention wherein a plurality of optionally superconducting devices are implemented as a layer on a flexible or contoured substrate.
- Prefabricated die 231 and 239 each bearing a plurality of microelectronic devices, are affixed to opposing faces of a single substrate 230 .
- Capacitive signalling between die 231 and 239 is provided by coupled half-capacitors 232 and 238 , also implemented on or otherwise affixed to opposing faces of substrate 230 and advantageously need not be planar.
- both the microelectronic devices and the half-capacitors are advantageously implemented in substrate 230 by monolithic fabrication techniques.
- regions of material may be deposited onto substrate 230 or otherwise processed into it (e.g., by ion implantation).
- Josephson Junction devices may be implemented in a (preferably high-T c ) superconducting thin film painted or otherwise deposited onto substrate 230 .
- Substrate 230 is contoured so as to provide adequate capacitive coupling between half-capacitors 232 and 238 . Although illustrated as a simple U-shape, other shapes for substrate 230 , such as spirals or coaxial cylindrical shapes, may also be used.
- Dies 231 and 239 , as well as half-capacitors 232 , 238 , optical sensor 240 and power contact pad 241 are preferably fabricated prior to deformation of substrate 230 .
- Substrate 230 may be formed either from two or more distinct pieces bonded or otherwise melded during manufacture, from a flexible material, or from a single piece of rigid material deformed during manufacture by heat or other appropriate treatment.
- Power and ground may be provided to the devices by conductive or radiative contact to power pad 241 , or by on-board batteries.
- AC powering means 235 may communicate power to pad 241 without need for mechanical contact.
- External signalling is advantageously provided by a lightpipe 234 optically coupled, through dielectric 237 , to an optical sensor (or driver) 240 .
- an optical sensor or driver
- capacitive or magnetic means may be used.
- FIG. 15 depicts the use of a uniform capacitive interface to couple modules of varying sizes and packaging levels.
- the use of a uniform capacitive interface 276 on module 274 and a uniform capacitive interface 275 on modules 277 a - c permits interchangeable connection of modules 277 a - c to module 274 .
- Capacitive interfaces 275 and 276 are illustratively depicted as a single half-capacitor and a half-capacitor with bonded dielectric portion, respectively. In actual systems, such capacitive interfaces will preferably comprise a plurality of half-capacitors (and optional conductive contacts) disposed in a standardized footprint.
- capacitive interface 276 may more half-capacitors than are coupled to interface 275 , the additional half-capacitors on interface 276 being used to accommodate coupling to test-modules, engineering changes, etc.
- modules 277 a - c illustratively represent different levels in the packaging hierarchy: module 277 a illustratively comprises a Level-0 unpackaged die; module 277 b illustratively comprises a Level-2 packaged module; and, module 277 c illustratively comprises a Level-2 or Level-3 packaged module.
- a given module is preferably implemented initially utilizing a semicustom assembly of standard or semicustom parts (e.g., modules 277 b or 277 c ).
- the module may be advantageously reimplemented as a custom ASIC die (e.g., module 277 a ) and installed into the product without need for any higher-level system modifications.
- Other sequences of product evolution such as replacement of module 277 c with 277 b or replacement of either with a Level 11 ⁇ 2 MCM implementation, are also possible within the scope of the present invention.
- modules 277 a - c may be view as different implementations of a functional block of a massively parallel computer.
- the computer manufacturer could alternatively install a low performance module 277 a , a medium performance module 277 b , or a high performance module 277 c .
- such functional modules can be advantageously upgraded as the overall requirements of a particular system in the field evolves.
- a pervasive problem in hierarchically decomposing a design in the prior art encompasses the partitioning of high level functions, followed by the discovery that a low level module cannot be implemented effectively in a given technology, followed by the need to repartition at a high level again to avoid the suboptimal (e.g., very expensive) technology mix.
- Underlying both the improved product evolution and system evolution provided by the invention is the fact that the invention permits implementation of common dense, high performance interfaces uniformly to all the levels in the packaging hierarchy.
- the hierarchical decomposition design process can exploit a uniform interface and functional specifications for each submodule in accordance with the invention.
- the invention's support for common interfaces assures that a submodule specified early can be implemented late in the process, even if multiple dies or different technologies are needed to accomplish the function.
- the invention greatly enhances a designer's ability to exploit hierarchical decomposition, since the implementation of particular modules in a hierarchical system is not necessarily constrained by the interfaces between modules. If, as the implementation proceeds, the anticipated technology proves inappropriate for implementing a submodule, an alternative technology or MCM can generally be substituted without reworking higher-order partitions.
- FIG. 16 depicts a modular system in which a plurality of modules capacitively couple to a substrate mounted to a supporting chassis, illustratively depicted as a backplane.
- Substrate 278 comprises the backplane and includes a plurality of module mounting supports 279 a - c .
- Supports 279 a - c are preferably fabricated from a material of high thermal conductivity, so as to enhance heat dissipation from the modules 280 a affixed thereto.
- Each backplane slot 281 preferably accommodates a modular subsystem 282 , illustratively mounted on support 279 a and depicted in an exploded view adjacent to support 279 b.
- Modular subsystem 282 includes a plurality of dies 280 a - b and a bridging substrate 280 c .
- Die 280 a capacitively interconnects to die 280 b .
- Conductive power connections are not shown; these can be implemented as shown in FIGS. 4-6 .
- Bridging substrate provides a capacitive signal path between die 280 a and substrate 278 .
- Substrate 278 preferably includes a plurality of terminated transmission lines (not depicted, but generally as shown in FIG. 5 ) which interconnect the various modular subsystems 282 .
- FIG. 17A depicts a perspective of a prior art face-up level 1 package.
- a single die 289 m typically formed of silicon, is supported by a substrate 289 n , typically formed of an epoxy or ceramic material.
- a plurality of power leads 289 g and signal leads 289 e are typically formed from aluminum struts.
- Power leads 289 g conductively contact power/ground contact pads 289 i via wire-bonds 289 h ; ground and power rails 289 k distribute voltage to circuits implemented on die 289 m .
- Signal leads 288 e conductively couple to I/O circuitry 288 a by means of low-resistance fan-out 288 b , contact pads 288 c , and wire-bonds 288 d.
- FIG. 17A illustrates a fundamental disadvantage of the prior art: useful real estate on die 289 m is wasted to support conductive signalling to other chips and/or other package levels.
- such real estate for signalling includes contact pads 288 c , low-resistance fan-out 288 b to the pads, and drivers/receivers 288 a .
- the prior art also requires bond wires 288 d and the package itself 288 n . If pads 288 c are limited to the periphery of the die 289 m (thereby shortening fan-outs 288 b ), additional real estate may be needed to provide enough perimeter area to accommodate the pads.
- designs requiring a high density of I/O terminals further increase the fraction wasted chip real estate.
- the presence of substrate 289 n increases the size of the overall package assembly to many times of that the bare die 289 m.
- FIG. 17A also depicts some of the sources of reliability and performance problems commonly encountered in the prior art.
- the series inductance of a contact junction 288 b - 288 c and bond lead 288 d is typically very high (e.g., 0.05-10 nH), and serves as a low pass filter, thereby necessitating more power to drive signal lines at higher clock rates.
- Conductive contacts are large relative to logic gates, and do not scale desirably as clock rates increase and lithographic dimensions decrease.
- conductive contact junctions entail mechanical contact, thereby limiting ability to assemble and disassemble the connections to die 289 m and decreasing the reliability of such connections.
- FIG. 17B depicts an exploded view of illustrative flip-chip Level 1 modular system implemented in accordance with the present invention.
- Substrate 289 f mates with die 289 e , and advantageously provides signalling interconnections 289 b , preferably implemented as terminated transmission lines.
- Power/ground contact pads 289 i mate reversibly with conductive fuzz buttons 289 c so as to provide a reversible conductive interconnection between substrate 289 f and die 289 e .
- substrate 289 f can be adapted such that contact pads 289 i mate with conventional conductive contacting means, such as solder bumps, wire-bonds, pins or ball grid arrays.
- Fan-outs 289 k distribute power to various circuits implemented on die 289 e .
- One or more drivers and/or receivers 288 a preferably utilizing pulse signalling and implemented underneath half-capacitor plates 289 a , signal between matched half-capacitor plates 289 a - aa across a gap.
- the gap is preferably filled with a material having a high die electric factor.
- the cost per square inch of substrate of 289 f and the associated dielectric is roughly comparable to that of substrate of 289 n .
- substrate 289 n is likely to be smaller than substrate 289 f
- the invention provides reduced substrate cost as well. Since the system of the invention ( FIG. 17B ) is generally denser than the prior art system ( FIG. 17A ) the invention will require shorter signal lines, thereby decreasing latency and attenuation loss.
- FIGS. 18 A-C depict several steps in the assembly of an MCM (such as those of FIGS. 4-5 ) in accordance with the invention. While a number of methods could be used, FIGS. 18 A-C illustrate an approach which uses a vacuum hold-down during assembly.
- a plurality of die 503 are aligned with a high resolution substrate 503 , coated with a dielectric 502 , using optical feedback and fiducial marks on both die and substrate.
- Such fiducials can be tracked through holes in the substrate under the die, or by infra-red imaging through silicon wafers.
- Registration of the die 503 can be verified, and alignment refined, by measuring and maximizing the capacitance between selected pairs of die and substrate half-capacitors. Interferometry by the pick'n'place apparatus may also be used.
- a vacuum is drawn under substrate 501 —by vacuum chamber 505 , vacuum hose attachment 506 and O-ring 504 —so as to hold the die 503 firmly in place.
- an elastomeric thermal conductor 511 and pressure plate/heat sink 510 are then positioned and locked into contact with the back side of the die 503 by bolts 512 and nuts 513 , thereby forming a rigid assembly.
- the rigid assembly is inverted and conductive contacts 521 are placed into the high resolution substrate 501 .
- the power substrate 520 is placed over the contacts. Assembly of the module is completed by compression of the power substrate against the pressure plate using bolts 522 and nuts 523 .
- An advantageous alternative assembly technique involves the use of ultra-violet curable adhesives.
- the substrate is coated with a dielectric material, a UV curable adhesive is applied, the die are then individually positioned and aligned, and UV radiation is applied to cure the adhesive.
- FIG. 19 depicts a capacitive signal path including means for adjusting overall gain.
- the need for gain adjustment may arise from a number of factors, including lateral and/or angular misalignments of the half-capacitor plates (from construction or thermal expansion), processing variations affecting transmitters or receivers, variations or non-linearities in the dielectric, and so forth.
- transmitter 286 a in response to an input signal on signal line 286 b , generates signals on half-capacitor 286 c .
- receiver 287 a in response to the signals received at half-capacitor 287 , generates an output signal on signal line 287 b.
- FIG. 19 depicts several means for adjusting the overall gain of the capacitively coupled signal path in order to optimize the signal-to-noise ratio between input 286 b and output 287 b : (1) the gain of transmitter 286 a may be adjusted; (2) a trim plate (a/k/a “platelet” 286 d may be ganged in parallel with or disconnected from half-capacitor 286 c ; (3) trim plates 287 d - dd may be ganged in parallel with or disconnected from half-capacitor 287 ; and/or, the gain of receiver 287 a may be adjusted.
- Transmitter configuration means 286 e controls the gain of transmitter 286 a and/or the connections between trim plate 286 d and half-capacitor 286 c .
- receiver configuration means 287 e controls the gain of receiver 287 a and/or the connections between trim plates 287 d - dd and half-capacitor 287 c .
- the use of such configuration means generalizes easily to differential signal paths as well.
- Adjustment of capacitive signal path gain can be either static or dynamic. Static adjustment is preferably performed prior to assembly (i.e., mating of 286 and 287 ) and compensates for variances in the manufacture of dies 286 and 287 . The goal is to avoid a situation in which a particularly weak transmitter is paired with a particularly weak receiver. Static adjustment of die 286 involves temporarily affixing die 286 to a well characterized test die. The test die receives pulses from die 286 and provides feedback used to program transmitter configuration means 286 e , thereby configuring the gain of transmitter 286 a within the ordinary tolerance. Static adjustment of die 287 involves an analogous procedure wherein a temporarily affixed test die applies well characterized pulses to die 287 , so as to enable appropriate programming of receiver configuration means 287 e.
- Dynamic configuration compensates for gain variances that arise either during manufacture of modules 286 and 287 or during operation of the assembled system. Dynamic configuration is preferably performed during system operation by adjusting the configurations of transmitter configuration means 286 e and/or receiver configuration means 287 e so as to optimize the signal-to-noise ratio across the capacitive signal path. Various techniques are known in the telecommunications industry for performing such configuration. The periodicity with which such dynamic adjustments need to be performed will vary anywhere from once at power-up to many times per second, depending on surrounding environmental conditions such as temperature fluctuations and mechanical stresses, among other things.
- the larger system preferably provides storage means, analysis & data reduction means, diagnostic means, and reporting & auditing means, as well as other services.
- the larger system may co-optimize the settings in configuration means 286 e and 287 e together, advantageously as a function of data from both, advantageously including sensory data.
- FIGS. 20 A-B depict an exemplary application specific module (ASM) constructed from application specific submodules (ASSMs) in accordance with the invention.
- ASM application specific module
- ASSMs application specific submodules
- FIG. 20B depicts an exemplary ASM comprising ASSMs 186 a and 186 , conductively coupling power through solder bump 188 and capacitively signalling through dielectric 189 .
- Use of the assembly/testing techniques of the present invention permits very low cost and high yield, high reliability fabrication of ASM 190 .
- FIG. 20A depicts ASSMs 186 a and 186 prior to mating. Only a portion of ASSM 186 is depicted; ASSM 186 may advantageously mate with more than one other ASSM 186 a . Either or both of ASSMs 186 a and 186 may be custom fabricated utilizing ASIC-like techniques and/or otherwise personalized by the techniques used to customize (field) programmable logic parts.
- ASSMs 186 a and 186 each preferably include a plurality of electronic devices 184 a and 184 b , respectively.
- Conductive contact pads 181 a and 181 b are configured to accommodate a solder ball 188 or the like, so as to provide a means for powering ASSM 186 a from ASSM 186 .
- Capacitive signalling between devices 184 a and 184 b is provided via wiring 185 b , driver/receiver 183 b , coupled half-capacitors 182 b and 182 a , driver/receiver 183 a and wiring 185 a .
- ASSM 186 optionally includes additional wiring 185 c , driver/receiver(s) 183 c and half-capacitor(s) 182 c to accommodate additional ASSM(s).
- Cable 410 comprises an outer sheath 418 encapsulating a plurality of transmission lines 413 disposed in an appropriately selected dielectric inner medium 419 .
- Transmission lines 413 each preferably connect to half-capacitors 414 at interface 412 so as to form a standard interface adapted to mate with another capacitively terminated cable or socket.
- Interface 414 preferably includes means 415 for affixing 410 to another cable or connector socket, which may entail mechanical guides, optical positioning, registration marks, or other means for positioning and holding the cable 410 to another device's interface.
- Interface 414 may be flat or patterned to enhance alignment stability.
- Cable 410 may additionally incorporate one or more lines adapted for conductive interconnection at interface 414 .
- half-capacitor cable interfaces in accordance with the invention provides numerous advantages over conventional cable connections. Coupled half-capacitors allow substantially better impedance matching at the interface than conventional conductive interfaces. In addition, the invention permits substantially denser interconnections at the interface. Also, capacitive cable interfaces are simpler to fabricate and offer higher reliability (in terms of resistance to contamination corrosion) than conventional conductive cable connections.
- FIG. 22 depicts an exemplary portion of a modular electronic system wherein a substrate provides both inter-chip and intra-chip capacitive signal paths.
- Inter-chip capacitive signal path 402 interconnects chips 401 a and 401 b .
- Intra-chip capacitive signal path 403 b interconnects two points on chip 400 a via a transmission line and two half-capacitors on substrate 404 .
- Intra-chip capacitive signal path 403 a similarly interconnects two points on chip 400 b .
- signal paths need not be simply inter-chip or intra-chip.
- the pattern of transmission lines on substrate 404 may include branches which implement a hybrid signal path, providing both inter-chip and intra-chip interconnections.
- Chips 400 a and 400 b are illustratively depicted as being powered by conductive power connections 401 a and 401 b , respectively, from substrate 404 .
- a powering means such as 401 b might provide connectivity to a battery supply comprised by the chip 400 b , the substrate 404 , or elsewhere in the system, preferably eliminating the need for external power connections.
- Numerous means for powering electronic devices are well-known in the art and may be employed advantageously alongside the invention.
- FIG. 23A depicts an exemplary apparatus for testing modules constructed in accordance with the invention.
- a module-under-test 296 couples capacitively to a test-module 297 , which drives test vectors and receives (and optionally evaluates) test signals.
- the electrical interface to test-module 297 can be made essentially identical to the interface that module-under-test 296 will see when installed in an actual system. Therefore, module-under-test 296 can be tested at full speed without any need to over-design the drivers on it to accommodate the higher parasitics of a testing fixture.
- the apparatus permits circuits being tested in module 296 to be operated at full speed with essentially no parasitics. Except for latency, the test signals can be made substantially the same as those seen when coupled to a second “real” module, and the latency can be made arbitrarily small.
- the invention preferably utilizes capacitive alignment in which a tuned circuit on the module-under-test 296 or on test module 297 is used to servo a capacitance extremization (and thus alignment) between certain half-capacitors on module-under-test 296 and test-module 297 .
- capacitive alignment advantageously obviates any need for expensive optical alignment equipment.
- other circuitry can instead be used to facilitate the alignment process, although tuned circuitry is advantageous and capacitive means may be preferable since already available.
- module-under-test 296 is positioned relative to test-module 297 and mated such that signals can pass between a plurality of respective coupled half-capacitors 296 a and 297 a .
- Respective conductive connections 296 b and 297 b allow test-module 297 to provide power to module-under-test 296 during the testing cycle, and possibly during a fine alignment cycle.
- the test assembly 296 - 297 is durable and may advantageously be constructed by a process of building or unbuilding modules 296 and 297 , without requiring any positive or negative insertion force or energy changes across the signal junctions 296 a - 297 a . It preferably does not require sacrificial test-rigs, nor the severing or joining of conductor-conductor signal junctions.
- test-module 297 includes a plurality of testing circuits, each associated with one or more particular half-capacitors 297 a and adapted to generate and/or evaluate test signals at the particular half-capacitor(s).
- Such testing circuits implemented on the active surface of test-module 297 preferably near or beneath half-capacitors 297 a ) substantially increase the bandwidth of the testing process.
- a wafer-scale test-module 297 may also be advantageously used as a micrometer caliper when many components are assembled into a multichip module, thereby effectively providing long-distance fiducials.
- Module-under-test 296 need not be passivated. Indeed, a high dielectric factor material may advantageously be disposed on the plurality of half-capacitors 297 a , and not on half-capacitors 296 a , to lower manufacturing costs and simplify testing. Use of a lower-than-designed dielectric factor or greater separation can advantageously help identify weak drivers or receivers. Likewise, a higher-than-designed dielectric factor or smaller separation can advantageously simulate over-strong communications circuitry. Varying separation and/or alignment between module-under-test 296 and test-module 297 during parametric testing may be used to simulate various environmental extremes. As a result, full parametric testing can be done easily, exercising permutations of extreme variance in clock rate, temperature, voltage, and so forth.
- module-under-test 296 is powered through a conductive connection between respective contact points 296 b and 297 b formed from reversible fuzz buttons, compliant conductive material, or AMPSTARTM—like springy contacts.
- testing protocols discussed in regard to FIGS. 23A, 25 and 26 are exemplified with reference to the testing of an undiced semiconductor wafer, these testing protocols are applicable to modules at any level in the packaging hierarchy, to the extent that such higher-level modules employ the capacitive interfaces associated with the invention.
- Testing of modules constructed in accordance with the invention affords significant advantages, compared to testing of conventional, conductively interconnected modules.
- One advantage is the substantially reduced cost of the test fixture (e.g., test-module 297 ).
- the cost of conventional testing depends largely on the number of conductive connections between fixture and module-under-test.
- a conventional system requires conductive signal connections for each node being stimulated and each node being observed, as well as conductive connections for powers and grounds.
- the present invention eliminates the need for all these conductive connections, except for powers and grounds (e.g., 296 b and 297 b ).
- power and ground may be applied to module-under-test 296 via a network on the back side 296 c , thereby completely eliminating the need for conductive connections between module-under-test 296 and test-module 297 .
- the cost of a non-conductively coupled test-module 297 will generally be substantially less than the cost of a comparable conductively coupled fixture.
- the present invention provides substantially increased controllability and observability of module-under-test 296 .
- This capability to provide very high interconnection density between module-under-test 296 and test-fixture 297 is particularly valuable in the testing of very small modules (e.g., silicon dies) and makes economically feasible the manufacture of larger and/or denser circuitry on such modules because of the increased capability and reduced cost of the testing process.
- the invention provides novel testing methods which dramatically reduce these costs. These methods reduce the problem of identifying Known Good Die[s] (which in the prior art typically entails packaging a die in a sacrificial test rig and tolerating poorly matched or poorly characterized parasitics) into the Known Good Chip problem whose treatment is well-known by practitioners in semiconductor fabrication. Moreover, packaged chips can still be tested after assembly into a module, just by opening the module and removing some of the high resolution signal substrate or other chips overlaying the suspect chip. A specialized test rig can then be applied directly to the chip, either in situ or after removal from the module.
- test-module 297 advantageously incorporates test-circuitry (not depicted) operable to apply and/or receive and evaluate test data from module-under-test 296 via half-capacitors 297 a .
- test-circuitry provides in effect a “built-in self-test” (“BIST”) capability, but without the disadvantages of conventional approaches.
- BIST built-in self-test
- significant real estate on the module-under-test must be used to implement the testing circuits, which increases the cost, decreases the performance and decreases the yield of the module-under-test.
- test circuitry allows test circuitry to be implemented on the test-module (as opposed to the module-under-test), it eliminates these problems of conventional built-in self-test, while retaining the advantages of low cost for test equipment and procedures, high observability/controllability, high testing bandwidth, and so forth.
- test-circuitry into test-module 297 in accordance with the invention enables a variety of novel approaches for testing, verifying and repairing modular electronic systems.
- Self-test circuits can still be built in, but do not need to be built in.
- the test method does not disadvantage or rule out the use of boundary scan methods, examination by electron beams, or the use of plasmas for testing, but it makes them less necessary by comparison.
- the present invention permits changes to the “built-in” testing hardware (i.e. test-circuitry on test-module 297 ) usually without requiring any changes to the part being manufactured (i.e. module-under-test 296 ), thereby substantially reducing the cost and risk associated with changes in the testing process of a production part.
- different test-modules 297 may be advantageously employed to qualify a module-under-test 296 for different specifications, such as military, high-speed commercial, or low-cost commercial.
- the method and apparatus can test or validate any module 296 , so any module which can be built can be tested.
- any module which can be built can be tested.
- testing is advantageously performed before spending money to package the module-under-test, which is often infeasible in the prior art.
- FIG. 23B depicts the use of mated, undiced wafers to implement fault-tolerant, wafer-scale modular electronic systems in accordance with the invention.
- Important examples include applications for a breadboard (optionally including a routing network), for wafer-scale integration per se, and in multi-die systems of wafer-scale or smaller.
- Breadboards serve purposes well-known to practitioners in the field, such as providing a readily customized routing network.
- the off-die connectivity of a wafer-scale module 396 may be defined by customizing the interconnections on interconnection substrate 397 , capacitively coupled to the wafer-scale module.
- Such personalized interconnections can be made durable enough to be “shipped,” not just handled in a laboratory.
- Most of the uses and benefits of wire-wrap coupling can be exploited by breadboard-like interconnection substrates 397 using capacitive coupling, but without paying wire-wrap's penalties for size, power, reliability, durability, parts count, or other factors.
- the interconnections on interconnection substrate 397 are advantageously made electrically configurable by use of programmable logic devices (PLDs).
- PLDs programmable logic devices
- interconnection substrate 397 can be lithographed or assembled in one piece in a fixed amount of time, rather than wired in a time proportional to the number of leads.
- interconnection substrates are mechanically stable and compact enough for commercial production runs.
- submodules may readily be swapped in or out by replacing, reconfiguring, or otherwise altering the interconnection network represented on 397 .
- Unneeded good dies on wafer-scale module 396 can be powered or unpowered, depending on the maintenance strategy.
- Extra good functional units, so called “hot spares,” may be advantageously exploited through adaptive configuration or targeted compiler output.
- VLIW compiler techniques can be used to generate object code optimized to the custom configuration of circuits found to be good on the wafer-scale module 296 .
- routing networks offer a general means for redefining paired couples 297 a - 397 a .
- routing networks may be advantageously used to reconfigure the configuration of module 297 by rerouting signals from the half-capacitors 297 a associated with defective test circuitry to other functioning test circuitry during a second testing phase; the second phase tests the circuits on module-under-test 296 missed during the first testing phase.
- interconnection substrate 397 can be personalized either through hardware configuration or software programming of an incorporated routing network.
- customization of a coarse resolution substrate entails opening or closing connections among leads, using any of a variety of techniques. Cutting connections is the simplest.
- Customization at the high resolution substrate could be done in a number of ways, including metallizing leads, opening or closing fuses with a laser, or voting.
- Various xerographic or mundane photoresist processes might be employed to create custom multilayer high resolution interconnect substrates rapidly.
- Buses or routing networks can be made fully general, independent of the detailed fault map, for a bounded fault density. They can also be reconfigured dynamically, allowing hot restart with spare dies.
- the fault tolerant routing network or bus may be a significant, even dominant, portion of the overall real estate of a wafer such as 296 .
- Fault tolerant interconnection mechanisms become important in systems with a large number of components, at the system level if not at the module level. Implementation details of such schemes are available in published literature.
- One can avoid global interconnect schemes by developing locally fault tolerant clusters, leaving longer distance interconnects possibly fault intolerant. For example, nine adders might be fabricated into a cluster requiring eight, with entirely local circuitry concealing a bad unit. No external customization of interconnect wiring would then be needed.
- FIGS. 24 and 25 compare the fabrication of MCMs in the present art ( FIG. 24 ) and the fabrication of wafer-scale modules in accordance with the invention ( FIG. 25 ).
- prior art assembly methods typically entail an initial sequence of steps 420 a , 420 b , 420 c and 420 d , the output from which is a collection of individually separated, known good die; some methods swap the order of steps 420 b and 420 c .
- Assembly into the MCM typically proceeds in either of two ways. In a chips-first method (steps 420 e - f ), good die are assembled into a planarized wafer-like module, whereupon interchip wiring is implemented using a photolithographic process.
- the more common chips-last MCM assembly method involves implementing wiring on an MCM substrate onto which the known good die are bonded, by flip-chip, wire-bond or TAB.
- the known good die are subjected to substantial high-temperature and/or mechanically stressful processing steps after the initial step 420 b test that identified the die as good. Therefore, complete functional test of the assembled system (step 420 i ) is advisable to ensure a working multi-die system.
- FIG. 25 shows the assembly of a wafer-scale system in accordance with the invention proceeds initially, in steps 421 a - b , along the same course as the conventional manufacturing methods.
- Wafer-scale module 396 is not separated into individual die. Rather, in step 421 e , interconnection substrate 397 is personalized, in response to the results of step 421 b , so as to realize a pattern of interconnect, half-capacitors and/or power connections that will interconnect and power the known good die to form the desired system.
- step 421 f the unsawed wafer-scale module 396 is mated with the personalized interconnection substrate 397 to realize the wafer-scale modular system.
- Step 421 i optionally performs a final system test.
- the wafer-scale assembly method depicted in FIG. 25 does not subject the known good die to high-temperature or other physically stressful processing steps. Therefore, the likelihood that a die identified in step 421 b as good will fail at the final step 421 i test is dramatically reduced, as compared to the conventional methods of FIG. 24 . Moreover, even if such failures occur, rework in accordance with the invention is substantially simpler since it advantageously confines changes to the interconnection substrate 397 and does not require changes to the unsawed wafer-scale module 396 and since the mating to the unsawed wafer-scale module can be easily reversed without damage to either.
- Personalization of the interconnection substrate is advantageously performed by selectively deleting power and/or ground contacts, preferably fuzz buttons like metallic protrusions 397 k , corresponding to known bad dies from a coarse resolution power substrate portion of the interconnection substrate.
- Bad dies will therefore not be powered, so shorts or other defects in them can be electrically isolated from the system.
- This process of editing out defects by deleting connections to power and/or ground isolates bad dies as effectively as sawing them out would, for any point defect or region defect of the unsawed wafer; equivalently, power connections could be enabled only for known good die.
- interconnection substrate 397 can be fabricated by a number of methods, including those taught earlier. It may be the same size as the unsawed wafer 396 or composed of regularly or irregularly tiled smaller sections. It may also be built of one or more wafers or dies itself. Leads can be brought outside through fuzz buttons at the same cost as in conductively coupled systems, and breadboarded or connected to other components in a traditional fashion.
- the gutters needed when die are to be sawed are typically 300-900 microns wide, and restricted to having common edges abutting chords across the wafer, typically in a rectangular grid.
- the embodiment taught above removes the requirement for colinearity, which makes available the real estate padded out to form rectangular dies from non-rectangular layouts, and facilitates the placement of fabrication process control cells, which, in the prior art, are typically lithographed in the gutters.
- wafer-to-wafer variances in device parameters are not relevant.
- a module 431 is initially provided from existing prefabricated stock (e.g., a configurable array or the like) or manufactured by manufacturing means 430 .
- Module 431 is characterized by testing means 433 to produce a description 434 of its actual performance.
- layout generation means utilizes well-known CAD techniques to generate a geometric description 436 of an interconnection substrate.
- substrate generation means 437 personalizes an interconnection substrate 442 .
- Assembly means 432 then assembles substrate 442 and the wafer 431 into a (potentially operable) module 443 .
- System testing means 440 compares the behavior of module 443 with a description of the desired system behavior. If module 443 tests acceptably, system testing means 440 designates the module as a known good module 441 . If, on the other hand, it identifies problems in the performance of module 443 , system testing means 440 generates rework instructions 438 for substrate generation means 437 , in which case a new or reworked interconnection substrate is created and tested.
- the invention further provides advantages in terms of repair, optimization and/or rework of such modular systems. Since wiring is advantageously disposed on mated modules, a die or submodule identified as bad can be identified and swapped out with much less tear-down and rebuild than would be required in test-replace cycles for conductively coupled systems in the prior art.
- Non-destructive assembly and disassembly in accordance with the invention advantageously allows full systems to be built for testing and torn down for repair with substantially no damage to submodules. Reparability is facilitated by the lack of impact on neighboring die, tolerance of alignment mis-registration, absence of metal fatigue, and simplicity of testing, among other factors.
- Rework involves disassembling a modular system and repairing or replacing a module so as to correct a performance deficiency.
- rework may be used not only to repair or replace inoperable modules, but also to repair or replace slow or otherwise suboptimal modules so as to improve the performance of an already operable system.
- the forming or breaking of capacitive signal junctions advantageously entails substantially zero force, sheer, torque, or change in energy across any pair of coupled half-capacitors.
- Such assembly or disassembly advantageously proceeds with: no rise or fall in temperature at the signal junctions; no application or removal of heat at the signal junctions; no severing or joining of conductor-conductor leads at the signal junctions; no melting, solidifying, or other phase changes at the signal junctions; and/or no use of conductive liquids, solids, pastes, gases, plasmas, solvents, suspensions, or combinations of these at the signal junctions.
- FIG. 27 shows the yield of good dies in a typical semiconductor fabrications process as a function of die size.
- a Poisson distribution of point-localized defects predicts defect-less yields of approximately 90% for 0.10 cm 2 die, 37% for 1.0 cm 2 die, and 5% for 3 cm 2 die, which are realistic figures for certain mature VLSI processes.
- a 60 cm 2 wafer would on average yield approximately 1good die of 3 cm 2 size, or 21 of 1 cm 2 size, or 540 of 10 mm 2 size.
- a good 10 cm 2 die will be found, on average, once every 22 ft 2 of wafer, and thus is not a practical design target.
- FIG. 28 depicts several plots of system cost as a function of die size for an exemplary capacitively interconnected system.
- FIG. 28 shows the value of fractionating large dies into smaller ones and coupling them together using the invention.
- the cost for a substrate to interconnect signal lines is assumed to be much, much smaller than the cost of the dies themselves, so can generally be ignored to a first approximation.
- a system requiring a certain amount of silicon real estate e.g., 10 cm 2 for useful circuitry
- trace 299 c in which the communication circuitry is assumed to scale as 0.5 mm 2 times the square root of the number of die into which the 10 cm 2 of system is packaged.
- FIG. 29 depicts the flow of a design cycle in accordance with the present invention.
- a system description 451 is provided to CAD means 450 , which advantageously utilizes performance, yield, reliability and cost models for available or manufacturable submodules to produce an optimized design for the modular system, which design is provided to stock or manufacturing means 452 as a list of parts 461 , to means for packaging and assembling 456 as a definition of geometry 454 , and to testing means 459 as a definition of the expected behavior of the system 453 .
- Parts 455 are provided to means for packaging and assembling 456 from stock or means for manufacturing 452 .
- the module 458 is assembled and provided to testing means 459 , which decides whether to designate the module as a known good module 460 or initiate a rework or continuation cycle 457 .
- CAD means 450 advantageously optimizes the partitioning of the modular system into modules.
- the present invention permits considerable flexibility in selecting the size of system partitions (e.g., die sizes) since it largely obviates the need to rely on standard pad fan-out and wire-bonding configurations. Therefore, yield modelling, as exemplified in FIG. 28 above, is advantageously incorporated into CAD means 450 and forms an integral part of the design process for semi-custom systems based on the present invention.
- yield models are advantageously derived by curve-fitting data from all available fabrication processes, in order to provide a library of yield models that CAD means 450 can use in optimizing the implementation of a capacitively interconnected system.
- CAD means 450 advantageously utilizes models of the electrical performance characteristics and other physical characteristics of the various technologies available to implement the modules of a capacitively interconnected system. Equipped with models of the cost, yield, performance and physical characteristics of various technology resources, the CAD means 450 employs well-known algorithms to optimize the partitioning and implementation of a semi-custom, capacitively interconnected system.
- Such optimization preferably includes: (1) the selection of the sizes and types of modules utilized to construct the system, (2) the assignment of logical subcomponents of the system to particular modules for implementation, and/or (3) the design of patterned substrates or like means for capacitively interconnecting the modules to realize the system.
- FIG. 30 depicts a block diagram of an off-die capacitive signal path in accordance with the invention.
- digital data 302 is: (1) input to transmitter 300 ; (2) coupled to die half-capacitor 15 a via transmission line or wire 32 a ; (3) coupled from substrate half-capacitor 14 a to substrate half-capacitor 14 b via transmission line or wire 34 ; (4) coupled from die half-capacitor 15 b to receiver 301 via transmission line or wire 32 b ; and (5) provided as digital output 304 from receiver 301 .
- Transmitter 300 and receiver 301 may be implemented on the same die 10 (an intra-die off-die signal path) or on different dies (an inter-die signal path). Transmitter 300 and receiver 301 are preferably implemented on the active surface of die 10 , preferably directly beneath half-capacitors 15 a and 15 b , respectively.
- Transmitter 300 transforms digital input data 302 to a form appropriate for transmission on the capacitive signal path. Such transformations might include, for example, level shifting, edge rate modification, phase, frequency or amplitude modulation of an appropriate carrier, coding of data using Non Return to Zero (NRZ) or Alternate Mark Inverse (AMI) techniques and the like.
- NRZ Non Return to Zero
- AMI Alternate Mark Inverse
- Receiver 301 preferably performs an inverse transformation on the signal received from die half-capacitor 15 b to generate digital output signal 304 .
- receiver 301 converts modulated signals coupled from substrate half-capacitor 14 b into digital data by detection, discrimination or pulse slicing techniques, or by recovery of AMI or NRZ data.
- the waveform coupled to the receiver on line 32 b is either a pulse or a level waveform.
- FIG. 30 depicts a single-ended capacitive signal path for illustrative purposes. It should be noted, however, that differential signalling, as depicted in later figures, is considered preferable. It should also be noted that a receiver or driver could be connected to more than one half-capacitor, and that both a receiver and a driver could be connected to a single half-capacitor or collection of capacitive coupling means. It should be further noted that transmission line 34 is merely exemplary. Receivers and/or transmitters could be implemented directly on substrate 11 , preferably beneath or near half-capacitors 14 a and/or 14 b.
- a transmitter includes a means 300 a for rapidly switching the output signal 32 a between two voltage levels 312 and 313 , the means for rapidly switching comprising switches 310 and 311 , controlled by control signals 314 a and 314 b , respectively.
- Control signals 314 a and 314 b are determined by the digital data 302 entering the transmitter.
- FIG. 31B depicts a preferred embodiment of the means for rapidly switching comprising a CMOS inverter 300 b .
- Inverter 300 b requires only a single control signal 314 , which controls both PMOS switch 315 and NMOS switch 316 .
- the switching means 300 a of transmitter 300 imparts a waveform on substrate half-capacitor 14 a (and transmission line 34 ) when output 32 a switches voltage levels. If transmission line 34 is terminated, the imparted waveform will be a pulse. If wiring is unterminated, the waveform will be a level voltage.
- Differential switching means 300 c comprises a control signal inverter 321 and four switches 322 - 325 .
- one of voltage levels 312 and 313 is selectively coupled to output line 32 a while the other voltage level is coupled to output line 32 aa.
- Die half-capacitors 15 a and 15 aa impart a differential waveform to their respective substrate half-capacitors (not shown) wherein each substrate half-capacitor sees a waveform of opposite polarity.
- the waveforms are pulse waveforms if the substrate transmission lines are terminated and level waveforms if the substrate transmission lines are unterminated.
- FIG. 33 depicts a simplified electrical model of the interface between an exemplary switching means 300 and a terminated substrate transmission line 330 .
- a level waveform 333 is applied to switching means 300 a , which couples a similar waveform to die half-capacitor 15 a .
- a pulse waveform 334 is imparted on substrate transmission line 330 .
- a termination resistor 331 connected between transmission line 330 and an AC ground 332 terminates transmission line 330 .
- FIG. 34 depicts a simplified electrical model of the interface between an exemplary switching means 300 and unterminated substrate wiring line 330 b .
- a level waveform 333 is applied to switching means 300 , which couples a similar waveform to die half-capacitor 15 a .
- a level waveform 335 is imparted on substrate wiring 330 b .
- Capacitor 336 represents the parasitic capacitance between unterminated wiring 330 b and AC ground 332 .
- a voltage divider is formed by capacitor 336 and the coupled half-capacitors 15 a and 14 a . Therefore, waveform 335 represents a reduced swing version of waveform 333 .
- digital data 302 is: (1) input to transmitter 300 a ; (2) coupled differentially to die half-capacitors 15 a and 15 aa via wiring 32 a and 32 aa ; (3) coupled differentially from substrate half-capacitors 14 a and 14 aa to substrate half-capacitors 14 b and 14 bb via wiring 34 a and 34 b , respectively; (4) coupled differentially from die half-capacitors l 5 b and 15 bb to receiver 301 a via transmission lines 32 b and 32 bb ; and, (5) provided as digital output 304 from receiver 301 a.
- Differential transmitter 300 a and receiver 301 a may be implemented on the same die 10 (an intra-die off-die signal path) or different dies (an inter-die signal path).
- Transmitter 300 a and receiver 301 a are preferably implemented on the active surface of die 10 , preferably directly beneath half-capacitors 15 a - 15 aa and 15 b - 15 bb , respectively.
- one side of the differential signal path can be employed as a “reference line,” for example, by enlarging half-capacitors 14 aa , 15 aa , 14 bb , and 15 bb.
- pulse or level waveforms on transmission lines 34 a and 34 b preferably convey digital information between transmitter 300 a and receiver 301 a .
- other differential signalling techniques such as those based on modulation of amplitude, phase, frequency or signal-to-noise ratio, may also be used to transmit data via the differential capacitive signal paths of the invention.
- Certain combinations of pulse and level waveforms offer advantageous implementations, such as a configuration wherein a transmitter drives a single-ended pulse and the receiver reads a differential signal, taking a level waveform, preferentially ground, as the other side of the difference.
- FIG. 36 is a schematic diagram of an exemplary single-ended receiver 301 compatible for use in the signal path depicted in FIG. 30 .
- Receiver 301 converts a pulse waveform received on half-capacitor 15 b and coupled via wiring 32 b to a digital output 304 .
- Receiver 301 comprises a biasing means 360 coupled to input line 32 b , a slicing means 361 also coupled to input line 32 b , and a pulse-to-level converter 362 coupled to the slicing means.
- Biasing means 360 comprises a resistive means 363 coupled to input line 32 b and a voltage generator means 364 coupled to the resistive means.
- Resistive means 363 preferably comprises an MOS transistor 365 .
- Voltage generator means 364 preferably comprises a feedback-connected CMOS inverter wherein the relative sizes of PMOS transistor 366 and NMOS transistor 367 are selected to provide the desired bias voltage. Preferably, this ratio of transistor sizes is the same as that for an ordinary inverter in the given process, so as to provide a bias voltage approximately equal to the switching threshold of an ordinary inverter.
- Resistive means 363 and voltage generator means 364 are designed to track process variations.
- a single voltage generator means 364 may be used in conjunction with multiple resistive means 363 to bias multiple half-capacitor plates 15 b.
- Slicing means 361 illustratively comprises a high-threshold inverter 368 and a low-threshold inverter 369 , both coupled to input line 32 b.
- High-threshold inverter 368 preferably comprises a CMOS inverter having a PMOS-to-NMOS size ratio larger than that of voltage generator 364 .
- low-threshold inverter 369 preferably comprises a CMOS inverter having a PMOS-to-NMOS size ratio smaller than that of voltage generator 364 .
- Slicing means detects deviations of the voltage on input line 32 b imparted by signals coupled from half-capacitor 15 b , as either pulse or level waveforms.
- the switching thresholds of inverters 368 and 369 advantageously track process variations.
- Pulse-to-level converter 362 comprises an R-S flip-flop, including inverter 372 and cross-coupled NAND gates 373 - 374 , all preferably implemented in CMOS. Pulse-to-level converter 362 effectively reconstructs the digital waveform driven by transmitter 300 on half-capacitor 15 a (See FIG. 30 ). Output 370 from slicing means 361 drives the Set input of pulse-to-level converter 362 , thereby driving digital output 304 low when a positive pulse or level change is imparted on input line 32 b .
- output 371 from slicing means 361 drives the Reset input of pulse-to-level converter 362 , thereby driving digital output 304 high when a negative pulse or level change is imparted on input line 32 b .
- Pulse-to-level converter 362 is preferably designed such that the timings in the Set and Reset paths of the R-S flip-flop are substantially identical, so as to provide a digital output waveform 304 having substantially the same timing as the digital input waveform 302 at transmitter 300 .
- FIG. 37 is a schematic diagram of an exemplary differential receiver 301 a compatible for use in the signal path depicted in FIG. 35 .
- Differential receiver comprises a biasing means 380 , a signal conditioning means 384 , a slicing means 361 and a pulse-to-level converter 362 .
- Receiver 301 a receives a differential pulse or level waveform input from half-capacitors 15 b - 15 bb and provides a digital output 304 .
- Biasing means 380 comprises a voltage generator means 383 , first resistive means 381 and second resistive means 382 .
- Voltage generator means 383 preferably comprises an ordinary sized, feedback-connected CMOS inverter.
- First resistive means 381 comprises an appropriately sized NMOS transistor connected between voltage generator means 383 and input line 32 bb .
- Second resistive means similarly comprises an appropriately sized NMOS transistor connected between voltage generator means 383 and input line 32 b .
- Biasing means 380 advantageously tracks process variations.
- Signal conditioning means 384 receives differential input from lines 32 b versus 32 bb and provides a single-ended output 390 , thereby enhancing the rejection of common-mode noise or other signals on input lines 32 b and 32 bb .
- Signal conditioning means 384 illustratively comprises a DMC differential amplifier, wherein an NMOS current source 385 and the gates of load devices 388 and 389 are self-biased by one output of the differential amplifier, and differential input from lines 32 b and 32 bb drives an NMOS differential pair 386 and 387 .
- signal conditioning means 384 provides an output 390 approximately equal to the switching threshold of an ordinary CMOS inverter when its inputs 32 b and 32 bb are approximately the same.
- the single-ended output from signal conditioning means 384 is provided to slicing means 361 , which drives the Set and Reset inputs 370 - 371 of pulse-to-level converter 362 to provide digital output 304 .
- Slicing means 361 and pulse-to-level converter 362 have been previously described in regard to FIG. 26 .
- FIG. 38A shows an exploded view of a modular system including a transmission line 471 on module 470 and a parallel transmission line 474 on module 473 . Coupled transmission lines 471 and 474 provide a means for non-conductively signalling between modules 470 and 473 .
- FIG. 38B shows an exploded view of an alternative arrangement, wherein transmission line 471 on module 470 and perpendicular transmission line 477 on module 476 couple magnetically, thereby providing a means for non-conductively signalling between modules 470 and 476 .
- Signalling means 472 comprises a transmitter and signalling means 475 comprises a receiver, and/or vice versa.
- the '321 patent differs from the present invention in at least two important respects: (1) the '321 patent does not teach the use of transmission line coupling to signal inter-chip between different modules in a modular system, or intra-chip via an off-chip path such as between two units of a chip via a distinct capacitively coupled substrate; and (2) the '321 patent expressly excludes “integrated circuits on silicon . . . operating at a low frequency.”
- transmission line coupling as depicted in FIG. 38 may be used in place of previously described half-capacitor coupling methods to implement a means for non-conductively signalling in accordance with the present invention, and that such alternative signalling means may thus be used in silicon-based systems such as CMOS.
- modular microwave and millimeter wave systems can advantageously employ transmission line coupling as a means for non-conductively signalling between modules in the system. Additionally, it may be advantageous to distribute clock signals and the like through coupled transmission lines. In these and similar circumstances, transmission line coupling and capacitive coupling represent alternative means for non-conductively signalling.
- the present invention encompasses modular electronic systems in which at least some of the modules communicate via coupled half-capacitors, coupled transmission lines, or both.
Landscapes
- Engineering & Computer Science (AREA)
- Physics & Mathematics (AREA)
- General Physics & Mathematics (AREA)
- Power Engineering (AREA)
- Computer Hardware Design (AREA)
- Microelectronics & Electronic Packaging (AREA)
- Condensed Matter Physics & Semiconductors (AREA)
- General Engineering & Computer Science (AREA)
- Computer Networks & Wireless Communication (AREA)
- Semiconductor Integrated Circuits (AREA)
- Testing Of Individual Semiconductor Devices (AREA)
- Testing Or Measuring Of Semiconductors Or The Like (AREA)
- Logic Circuits (AREA)
Abstract
A method and apparatus for constructing, repairing and operating modular electronic systems utilizes peripheral half-capacitors (i.e., conductive plates on the outside of the modules) to communicate non-conductively between abutting modules. Such systems provide lower cost, improved testability/repairability and greater density than conventional modular packaging techniques, such as printed circuit boards and multi-chip modules. The non-conductive interconnection technique of the invention can be applied to all levels in the packaging hierarchy, from bare semiconductor dies to complete functional sub-units. Numerous exemplary systems and applications are described.
Description
- Packaging Technologies
- The present invention relates generally to the field of electronic and microelectronic packaging and, more particularly, to a multichip package, a method for assembling, testing and repairing systems so packaged, and a method for communicating between circuits so packaged, via capacitive coupling. Of particular interest are digital systems, meaning systems which contain important constituents that operate according to the rules of multistate or binary logic.
- Electronic systems are usually implemented as hierarchical packages of components. Passive or active electronic elements, such as resistors and transistors, and their wiring are typically combined into memory or logic units, which are then combined into circuits and devices, which are combined into larger functional units, and so forth up to the level of a system.
- Each higher level of hierarchy grants the designer greater productivity, but compounds costs for connecting packages together logically and physically. Communication of data and timing among devices at each of these levels requires signal interconnection means, which the package provides. The package also provides powering means and fulfills other requirements such as physical support, heat removal and protection.
- By convention, there are five hierarchical packaging levels 0-4, although these levels are not rigidly defined. An exemplary scale in the hardware system hierarchy is the naked semiconductor wafer, sometimes called an undiced “
Level 0” package. Many components are formed simultaneously on a common substrate during fabrication stages, even if the substrate is subsequently separated into subunits. For instance, wiring, memory or logic gates may be assembled into integrated circuits on the surface of a semiconductor wafer and then cut into individual dies. Examples of dies include microelectronic devices implemented on semiconductor materials, superconductors bearing Josephson Junctions, and materials bearing other quantum interference devices. - Individual dies are typically mounted into “
Level 1” packages, which provide mechanical stability, protection, cooling and heat dissipation, power and grounding, and interconnection of signal lines (including clocking) to other packages. Examples include DIP, ceramic, surface mounted and socketed packages. - A “
Level 2” package is a module carrying one ormore Level 1 orLevel 0 packages and interconnecting their signal and power wiring. It typically comprises a printed circuit board (PCB), a printed wiring board (PWB), or a thermal conduction module, and may cluster one or more interconnected packages for these purposes. “Level 3” assemblies further organize theLevel 1 andLevel 2 packages, typically with backplanes, but do not differ conceptually fromLevel 2 orLevel 1 packages. The “Level 4” package canonically ties together the lower level packages with power supplies, environmental systems, mechanical systems, peripherals, and so forth to provide system functionality. - A multichip module (“MCM” or “Level 1½” package) provides modular functionality as a Level 2-like or Level 3-like package for holding and interconnecting multiple dies and/or associated interconnections. At a minimum, an MCM provides the signal distribution, and power is usually distributed by way of the MCM as well. The MCM may also, or merely, encapsulate its constituent dies as an
erstwhile Level 1 orLevel 0 package, thereby providing protection. It may also communicate the dies to a heat sinking substrate, thereby providing heat dissipation. - Strictly speaking, an MCM could be treated as a package at any level of hierarchy, as defined in practice by its interconnection topology. Note that the term “chip” is used interchangeably in the industry both in reference to
Level 0 dies andLevel 1 packages (e.g., a multichip module is usually in fact a multidie module). As used herein, the term chip refers to aLevel 0 package or die unless context indicates otherwise. The term “module” or “submodule” as used herein is intended to be general, and can refer to any package level, for example one ormore Level 0 dies, one ormore Level 1 orLevel 0 chips (packaged or not), and of course higher order ensembles. - Present MCM Technologies
- An MCM involves two or more dies, whether bare or encapsulated, mounted and conductively coupled to it. It provides power and inter-die signal wiring. In some MCM technologies, the dies are physically bonded to a substrate, and leads that are wire-bonded to peripherally positioned contacts (e.g., pins) supply the conductive connections between the dies and a multichip substrate. Other technologies utilize a “flip-chip” configuration in which the leads of the dies are positioned either peripherally or over much of the die area (such as a pin grid array (PGA) or solder bumps) and are soldered or otherwise bonded to respective contacts on the multichip substrate.
- Several families of multichip packaging technology are standard at present. The so-called MCM-L technology utilizes a laminated, organic board substrate to which dies are bonded by flip-chip, tape automatic bonding (TAB), or wire-bonding. In the MCM-C technologies, dies are attached either directly by flip-chip or indirectly in prepackaged carriers to a ceramic thick-filmed substrate. The ceramic substrate is formed either sequentially, by a print and fire process, or by lamination and sequential co-insertion of screened green sheets. The MCM-D technology utilizes deposited thin-film substrates to which dies are then attached as in MCM-C. There are also variations of these three basic MCM technologies. For example, a variation using plastic packages and involving molding compounds and lead frames is the so-called multichip plastic quad packs (MCM-P) technology. Another recent variation involves the use of deposited thin films on a ceramic multichip substrate, referred to alternatively as MCM-DC or MCM-CD, and typically provides inter-die signal wiring in the deposited polymer-metal thin-film layers and power/ground wiring in the co-fired ceramic thick-filmed substrate. All of these technologies are subjects of intense research and invention in industry and universities. (See Rao R. Tummala, “Multichip Packaging—A Tutorial.” Proc. of the IEEE, December, 1992.)
- Many approaches to the construction of high density multichip modules have been proposed. The IBM C4 technology attaches dies to the multichip module in a flip-chip face-down configuration. The arrangement minimizes the parasitic inductance of the package leads, and allows pad location at any point on the interior of the die. Typically, dies are attached to the module using a reflow-solder approach. Dies are bumped by bonding to each pad several layers of protective metalization followed by a 10-200 micron diameter solder ball. A plurality of dies are then accurately positioned on the multichip module, and reflow-soldered into place. Inspection of the solder joints can be done with thermographic or radiographic techniques, but may be difficult otherwise. Pad location is no longer limited to the die periphery, but is often constrained by thermal coefficient of expansion mismatch between silicon and module to lie within some radius of the center of the die. Repair is carried out by module heating, die removal, and reflow-soldering of replacement die.
- “Chips-first” face-up wire-bonding of silicon dies to high density silicon, ceramic, or copper-polyimide modules is similar to conventional hybrid manufacturing technologies, and shares difficulties in rework and bonding yield. The GE/TI process forms a planar wafer-like module from collections of selected loose dies placed face down on a flat surface, and then encapsulates it in a polyimide carrier. After curing, this carrier is flipped over, planarized, and used as a module for further (possibly multilayer) metalization. The major advantages of metalizing on top of planar ensembles of dies include the fine lithography achievable and very small interconnect parasitics.
- The process can also be generalized to stacks of dies in 3D. In the Irvine Sensors approach, dies with electrically insulated backs are designed with leads fanned-out to contact pads lined up along an edge, and stacked with those side pads aligned precisely. The exposed side is then cleaned and polished, and interconnect lines are metalized onto it. The package is extremely dense, although heat dissipation can become limiting, but leads must still travel out to the edge and back to route to other die.
- In the Cray Computer approach, holes are drilled into a stack of dies in a grid, plated to form a conductive contact with die vias, and then threaded with twisted gold wires, separating the die slightly and supporting them. The package is extremely dense and conceptually trivial, but extremely difficult to manufacture.
- Need for MCM Technology
- In the present art, it costs much more (in terms of power, latency, performance and circuit real estate) to signal off-die than to stay on-die. Off-die signalling designates communicating between two points, on the same die or different dies, using off-die wiring. A major design goal with the present art is therefore to increase the number of circuits on each die, increasing the ratio to expensive off-die interconnections. However, as the size of a die approaches some economically and technologically feasible limit, the probability that randomly occurring manufacturing defects will produce an unacceptable die rises exponentially in a Poisson distribution. Since slightly larger die yield at significantly lower rates, this so-called “surface-to-volume” (communication-to-computation) ratio severely constrains fabrication yield, hence cost per functioning die.
- The need for multichip technologies arises in large part from this inability to produce arbitrarily large semiconductor dies with acceptable yield. Practical limits on die size for a given technology force system designers to partition large digital systems among multiple dies. Unfortunately, such partitioning dramatically impacts system performance since inter-die communication typically inflates packaging costs by tens to many hundreds of percent.
- Multichip technologies also offer the possibility of reducing the cost of intra-die communication in modern CMOS technologies. If off-die signalling became somewhat less expensive than at present, at some point it would become preferable to on-die wiring for certain intra-die communication. The implications of this need to be recognized by practitioners of today's MCM art: Dies should be made smaller, at the expense of more interconnects per non-communication gate. Smaller dies have significantly higher yield and lower cost per area, so if designers could employ cheap inter-die communication on MCMs, they could transparently treat a multichip module as if it were a single enormous ensemble of electronic devices (including their interconnections), using small, very high yielding monolithic integrated circuit dies (and modules of them) as the subunits. This would be tremendously useful for designers and cost-effective for semiconductor foundries.
- Use of MCMs for intra-die signalling should also have important attractions for low impedance—hence low dispersion-signalling between points on the same die. Low dispersion broadcast is essential for clock distribution, and low dispersion point-to-point is useful in general.
- Another application for multichip technologies is in customizing on-die interconnects or engineering change pads. It is valuable to customize interconnects in the manner of a breadboard, within dies up to full wafer-size or among ensembles of dies, in order to rig together specialized functions, test performance, edit out defects, redefine a system's basic connectivity, or perform the functions of engineering change pads. At present, customization generally requires a lengthy (circa six week) logic array masking process, unreliable laser fusing/breaking of wiring junctions, significant expense in microfabrication of wiring, macro-scale (e.g., wire-wrap) assemblages, lack of durability (e.g., hand-wired jury-rigs), or a combination of these. The enormous value of customization can be exploited with properly designed MCMs.
- Inter-die signalling technology trends demand MCM technology. Shorter signal paths directly contribute to higher performance, since they allow shorter delays and faster clock rates (i.e. more operations per second) and wider synchronous instructions (i.e. more operations per clock tick). Dies are generally planar, so the longest signal path will scale as the diameter, or roughly as the square-root of the area. Planar MCMs can be constructed more densely with smaller dies since they ask less wiring overhead for excursions to the edge and back. In principle, the electronic devices a die bears that make it useful could be disposed volumetrically, but in the current art that is uncommon, except for on-die wiring and stacked capacitors. MCMs can in principle be constructed in a space-filling manner, so that the volumetric packing is denser than planar packing, hence signal paths are kept much shorter (e.g., proportional to the cube root of the chip package volume, which is small if the package is thin compared to its area).
- The cost of interconnection networks for signal lines generally scales as a function of area (i.e. a proxy for system real estate) and number of layers (i.e. density and layout efficiency), with linear scaling as a goal. The number of leads or number of chips within an area may inflate cost by a significant factor in many packaging technologies, such as those using wire-bonds. Even if a technology avoids scaling as the number of leads or die, if it requires post-processing steps to form a package, as with solder bump conductive couples, it may still be expensive due to yield losses from handling, amortization of costly test/repair cycles, and of course operating and capital costs.
- Even if a large and a small system have identical numbers of wires starting and stopping in each average square inch, the wires in the larger system will travel further on average, so account for a greater proportion of system density than in the smaller system. This is the well-known “Law of Numbers,” and is a dominant consideration in constraining layout to a minimum number of metalized layers, which generally rises (geometrically) faster than real estate as a chip design grows. Runaway wiring density can in principle choke off the manufacturability of large high performance systems. The requirement for high interconnection density makes MCMs almost inevitable, and rewards volumetric packing as well as the shorter Manhattan distances that accrue to volumetric interconnection.
- A further need for multi-chip technology arises from the cost and complexity of combining hybrid materials to exploit properties of each. For instance, an arbitrarily large, cheap silicon CMOS chip would still lack the speed and optical properties of GaAs, while growing one material on the other is inherently more complicated than forming them separately.
- A further need arises from the enduring value of packaging hierarchies, wherein standardized packages with well-described components, such as microprocessors, are available commercially with various advantages compared to components or full system-level packaging. Important advantages to using such hierarchies may include lower cost, modular upgradeability, well-characterized behavior, and multiple sourcing. The designer balances competing benefits and costs of a hierarchy: necessarily limiting the degrees of freedom of system design, while commensurately reducing complex system interactions and failure modes.
- A further need arises from the difficulty of package manufacture per se. The engineering or manufacturing complexity, process requirements, and cost of the package approach or exceed those of the die, so the cost and turnaround time for the package can become as formidable as those of the die.
- Problems of Present MCM Technologies
- Despite the intensive research efforts of the past several years, present day MCM technologies still have significant problems in terms of cost, performance, design, manufacturability, reliability and reparability, as well as shortcomings with respect to the needs enumerated above.
- Present MCM technologies require significant retooling and/or expensive reorientation of existing integrated circuit (“IC”) fabrication lines. High volume is needed to realize cost advantages of MCM packaging, but re-implementing an existing production system (for which high volume demand already exists) to utilize MCM technology typically requires extensive system-wide redesign. System vendors rationally resist such efforts, choosing instead to implement certain clusters of ICs as application specific Ics (ASICs), which generally involves only local redesign of
Level 2 boards andLevel 1 chips. Accordingly, the relatively high up-front cost of MCM implementation discourages use of MCM technology for systems where large volume cannot be predicted a priori. (See Balde, J. W., “Crisis in Technology: The Questionable U.S. Ability to Manufacture Thin-Film Multichip Modules.” Proc. of the IEEE, December, 1992.) - While the electrical performance of TAB, fine-line, or solder bump conductive interconnect can be significantly better than wire-bonding for a conductive interconnect, and pad count is somewhat less constrained, prior art MCM processes often require special processing of wafers or dies prior to assembly to place solder balls or construct metal bonding locations for assembly. The processes also require custom tooling and substantially more sophisticated wafer manufacture post-processing than would be required for standard wafer or packaging lines.
- Reparability and die attach yield issues also arise with current MCM technology, principally because of the difficulty in die removal and replacement. Testing the dies in the MCM before it is fully assembled (and paid for) typically accounts for tens of percent of the delivered MCM cost, due to the need for sacrificial test rigs or time-consuming intermediary connections as well as the cost of compensating for parasitics in order to test at operating speeds. Making physical contact with microscopic probes or rigs of probes is slow, and exposes the probe points to mechanical forces leading to misalignments, fatigue, and wearing. If the dies are packaged beyond
Level 0, only a fraction of the interconnects may even be visible. Nevertheless, working dies should be selected perfectly before module assembly, due to the expense (or impossibility) of reworking the module. Repair methods are very difficult-essentially a tear down and rebuild—and usually require essentially the same elaborate, expensive assembly technology as used to build the MCM originally. - The difficulties, mechanical constraints and costs of multichip module designs are largely driven by the drawbacks of conductive signalling per se. Conductive signalling is almost universally understood to be inevitable among practitioners of the present art (See Daryl Ann Doane and Paul D. Franzon, Multichip Module Packaging Technology and Alternatives. Van Nostrand Reinhold, 1993). Conductors in general must expose a face in contact to one another; they cannot hide behind shielding or a passivation layer. If there are (re)movable constituents in the electrical path, there will be exposed surfaces, and unless certain materials (e.g., noble metals) are used on exposed surfaces, conductors may be susceptible to oxidation, although some non-metallic conductors avoid the oxidation problems. Troublesome surface chemistry complications include mechanical stability (e.g., whiskering), finite conductance (e.g., charge carrier saturation), and time-dependent material or phase changes (e.g., intermetallic compounds). Non-metal conductors have other chemistry problems. If the entire path is bonded continuously, repair and testing may require physically severing material. Removing conductively mated dies, chips or modules for repair/replacement may entail cutting mechanical linkages and removing solder, metal-metal bonds, pins from sockets, or the like. Such breaks introduce metal fatigue (i.e. increase the likelihood of future failure modes) and contamination by conductive dust. The conductor-conductor junctions will later need to be realigned and restored. Intense localized thermal stresses from (de)soldering may also be involved. Methods for replacement pose severe constraints on the design and manufacture of conductively-coupled components in electronic systems.
- Even if these or other approaches were practical in a manufacturing sense, all suffer the series inductance performance costs of conductive signalling. The performance improvement achievable with solder-bumped or wire-bonded dies is fundamentally limited by the excessive series inductance of the solder bump or wire-bond interconnection. State-of-the-art MCM technologies endure much the same performance limitation as current surface mounted IC technologies. Both families of technology require bonding wires, solder bumps, TAB, or their equivalent, to couple signals conductively between the dies and the substrate (for MCMs) or
Level 2 package (for surface mounted ICs), which impose parasitic series inductance unavoidably. Parasitic inductance of 50-1000 pH is typical, and introduces significant latency, frequency limitations, and power requirements for signalling off-chip. While the best currently available MCM technologies reduce the disparity between on-die and off-die communication compared to the conventionally quoted ten-to-one ratio for surface mounted IC technologies, there remain significant penalties associated with inter-die signalling on conventional MCMs. Current MCM technologies suffer from mechanical and thermal problems, design and fabrication limitations, power costs, complexity, and expense. - With the present state of the art, technology for conductive signalling is itself directly responsible for many problems with current MCMS. It imposes mechanical and cost limitations on the density, number, and arrangement of signal leads attached to a MCM package or constituent dies in carriers, and generally requires further expense and yet more volume devoted to mounting and interconnecting the leads from chip packages onto
Level 2 circuit boards or multichip carrier modules and packaging at all higher levels.Typical Level 1 packages holding a die and its conductive leads are generally much larger than the active area of the containedLevel 0 die, due to requirements for spacing out contact pads and attached leads, and MCMs similarly inflate real estate requirements. On each die, fan-out of conductive leads (in order to simplify testing or wiring contact pads) takes up chip real estate. The practical need for a sufficient number of conductive pads, adequately large and well-separated, typically accounts for several tens of percent of the chip's real estate, but can range from a fraction of a percent to essentially all of the chip's real estate. With some MCM technologies, pad bonding locations cannot overlay active circuits, since applied contact probe pressure or other process steps risk damaging the circuits, so pads occupy real estate at the expense of useful electronic devices. That wasted real estate costs money (about $10-1000/square inch). Since present approaches emphasize placing the pads at the perimeter of the die's active area to minimize wiring lengths (or at the center, to minimize thermal expansion mismatch), and pad count is often limited by the available perimeter bonding density of the die, many designs are “pad limited,” wasting chip real estate, and/or “pin-limited,” leading to large, expensive packages. Other leads which can be used as pin-substitutes include solder, eutectic, or soft metal (e.g., gold) bumps, conductive wires (e.g., copper, silver, or aluminum) lithographed on polyimide or tape, and sharpened probe needles. - Current MCM technologies require special circuitry for interconnecting dies operating at different voltage levels. Dies fabricated from different materials generally use different voltage levels, such as CMOS versus GaAs. Dies designed with different circuit technologies, even in the same material, generally use different voltage levels, such as Si TTL versus Si ECL. Even dies fabricated from the same technology may still use different voltage levels, such as CMOS in silicon at 5.0 volts versus 3.3 volts.
- The circuitry supporting signalling is sensitive to manufacturing variations during wafer fabrication. Manufacturing processes produce variation in basic physical parameters (e.g., impedance, capacitance, inductance) absolutely and spatially, across a wafer or between wafers. This variation causes circuitry to produce waveforms of differing spectra, affecting shape and skew, and differing amplitude, affecting thresholds, noise susceptibility, power requirements and termination characteristics. Unreliable waveform spectra and amplitude means that the yield of dies follows a bell curve distribution, with very few able to operate at higher frequencies. Designers have therefore adopted conservative design rules to compensate for performance ranges.
- Power must still be provided to the electronic devices in a system, whether the devices are packaged in MCMs or any other level. Nearly all leading MCM designs treat power leads and signal leads the same way at
Level 1, which wastes space and loses important opportunities for increasing the density of signal lines. - In short, there remains a significant need for an improved method and apparatus for coupling signals among modules in a modular electronic system which mitigates one or more of the above-explained problems with the present MCM technology. While MCM technology represents an important application domain, the invention, as defined in the succeeding sections, applies broadly to all levels of electronic packaging and interconnection, such as die, wafer, board, MCM, system, etc. It is therefore the inventors'intent that the invention not be viewed narrowly, or only in the context of the preferred MCM embodiment, except where the context inarguably indicates otherwise.
- Objects of the Invention
- One object of the invention relates to a method and apparatus for interconnecting modules which mitigates one or more of the previously identified deficiencies in the prior art.
- Another object of the invention relates to a method and apparatus for coupling signals among modules which mitigates one or more of the previously identified deficiencies in the prior art.
- Another object of the invention relates to a method and apparatus for coupling signals among modules at very high speeds.
- Another object of the invention relates to a method and apparatus for providing improved inter-module and intra-module signal coupling without the need for costly or exotic fabrication techniques.
- Another object of the invention relates to a modular electronic system having shorter signal paths, and to a method for constructing such a system.
- Another object of the invention relates to a modular electronic system wherein at least some of the signals between two dies, between two substrates or between a die and a substrate communicate via capacitive coupling.
- Another object of the invention relates to a modular electronic system wherein at least some of the signals between two dies, between two substrates or between a die and a substrate communicate via magnetic coupling.
- Another object of the invention relates to a modular electronic system wherein a module couples both capacitively and conductively to other modules.
- Another object of the invention relates to a modular electronic system wherein a module couples both magnetically and conductively to other modules.
- Another object of the invention relates to a module adapted to couple capacitively or magnetically to other modules in a modular digital system.
- Another object of the invention relates to a method and apparatus for integrating modules of physically incompatible materials into a modular electronic system wherein signals couple between nearby, physically incompatible modules via capacitive or magnetic means.
- Another object of the invention relates to a method and apparatus for coupling signals between two or more modules without need for additional means to compensate for differences between the chemistry, conducting state, wave phase, fabrication technology, clock rates, voltage levels, numbers of logical states, thermal expansion properties, operating temperature, ambient pressure, or environmental requirements between components.
- Another object of the invention relates to a method and apparatus for coupling signals from or to a superconducting module.
- Another object of the invention relates to a module comprising a plurality of dies formed by several different fabrication technologies, and a method for assembling and testing such a module.
- Another object of the invention relates to a module comprising more technologies or devices than can be supported economically on a single die, and to a method for designing and laying out such a module.
- Another object of the invention relates to a module wherein the connections between dies, or between a die and a substrate, are easily reversible, and to a method for reversibly forming and breaking such connections.
- Another object of the invention relates to a method of repairing or replacing submodules without tearing down interconnection wiring.
- Another object of the invention relates to an MCM wherein neither the process of installing a die nor the process of removing a die damages either the die or a substrate.
- Another object of the invention relates to a method and apparatus for identifying and replacing undesirable modules in a modular electronic system.
- Another object of the invention relates to a method for improving the performance of a modular electronic system by full speed parametric testing of modules within the system.
- Another object of the invention relates to a method for improving the yield of a modular electronic system by full speed testing of modules within the system.
- Another object of the invention relates to a method for improving yield of an MCM by full speed testing of chips and larger modules prior to assembly.
- Another object of the invention relates to a method for improving the performance of a modular electronic system by selective replacement of modules within the system.
- Another object of the invention relates to an MCM comprising a plurality of known-good modules selected by testing in a test fixture having electrical properties substantially identical to those of the MCM substrate.
- Another object of the invention relates to an MCM wherein modules are selectively replaced in order to correct or improve system performance.
- Another object of the invention relates to modules adapted for full speed testing prior to installation in an MCM, and to a method for testing and installing such modules.
- Another object of the invention relates to an MCM wherein modules are attached to a substrate without use of solder or wire-bonding
- Another object of the invention relates to an MCM or other modular digital system wherein a clock signal is distributed with extremely low dispersion, and to a method of distributing clock signals with extremely low dispersion in such systems.
- Another object of the invention relates to an MCM wherein digital signals are communicated among dies via transmission lines on the substrate, the transmission lines being capacitively or magnetically coupled to the dies.
- Another object of the invention relates to an apparatus and method for coupling a transmission line to a means for capacitively signalling, and to a method and apparatus for terminating such couples.
- Another object of the invention relates to a transmission line connected between two means for capacitively signalling and adapted to provide a capacitive path between two separate modules.
- Another object of the invention relates to a method and apparatus for connecting two separate modules capacitively or magnetically by coupled transmission lines.
- Another object of the invention is a modular electronic system having improved signal-to-noise and higher speed transmission of digital signals between modules.
- Another object of the invention relates to a die wherein a substantial number of intra-die connections are routed via off-die signal paths, and a method of designing such a die.
- Another object of the invention is a modular electronic system having improved routing, busing, networking, or switching of signals among constituent modules.
- Another object of the invention relates to methods for laying out modular electronic systems—entailing optimizing interconnections among devices, circuits, blocks, and modules of any size—and to systems so implemented.
- Another object of the invention relates to design of a modular electronic system partitioned into a number of small, high-yielding dies and low cost, high performance inter-die connections.
- Another object of the invention relates to a module wherein the negative effects of misalignments from design, manufacture, assembly, or operation are substantially mitigated, and a method of isolating those effects.
- Another object of the invention relates to a method of designing, manufacturing, assembling, or operating a modular electronic system which removes the need for long-range physical alignment.
- Another object of the invention relates to a method and apparatus for self-aligning a modular electronic system electrically or logically.
- Another object of the invention relates to a method and apparatus for providing low-cost, defect-tolerant wafer-scale interconnections in a modular electronic system.
- Another object of the invention relates to a method for operating a wafer-scale module in spite of fabrication defects.
- Another object of the invention relates to a method and apparatus for reducing the number of packaging hierarchy levels needed for a modular system of a given complexity.
- Another object of the invention relates to a modular electronic system supporting many hierarchical layers of modules.
- Another object of the invention relates to a modular electronic system using standardized interconnections to serve as a building block for larger systems.
- Another object of the invention relates to a method and apparatus for standardizing the assembly of, and the interfaces between, modules in a hierarchical modular electronic system.
- Another object of the invention relates to a method and apparatus for reducing the cost of package engineering and manufacturing for modular electronic systems.
- Another object of the invention relates to a method and apparatus for reducing the turnaround time and cost for breadboarding or prototyping a modular electronic system.
- Another object of the invention relates to a method and apparatus for assembling a modular electronic system from a standardized kit of parts.
- Another object of the invention relates to a method and apparatus for reducing the turnaround time and cost for engineering and manufacturing the package for a modular electronic system.
- Another object of the invention relates to methods for designing, manufacturing, assembling, and operating systems which are faster, lower-powered, cheaper, or have more logical elements, and to systems so implemented.
- Another object of the invention relates to methods for designing, manufacturing, assembling, and operating systems which have preferable packages (e.g., denser, smaller, lighter, tolerant of planar or volumetric constraints), and to systems so implemented.
- Another object of the invention relates to modular electronic systems with a high density or number of signal interconnections, and to methods for constructing such systems.
- Another object of the invention relates to manufacturing and design methods for scavenging more real estate on wafers for electronic devices than results from methods used in the prior art, and to systems so implemented.
- One or more of the above objects, as well as other objects and advantages, are provided by the modular electronic system of the invention and the many uses thereof.
- Briefly, one aspect of the present invention relates to a modular electronic system comprising at least two modules, at least one of which is powered, and a means for non-conductively (e.g., capacitively or magnetically) communicating between the modules.
- Another aspect of the invention relates to an MCM wherein two or more dies communicate via non-conductive signalling means. The MCM preferably comprises a substrate having a plurality of dies affixed thereto. The means for non-conductively signalling preferably comprises coupled half-capacitors, one half-capacitor plate located on a die and the other located on the substrate or another die, the die and the substrate or other die positioned so as to couple the half-capacitor plates.
- Yet another aspect of the invention relates to a method and apparatus for assembling, testing and repairing modular electronic systems or MCMs based on the non-conductive signalling techniques of the invention.
- Still a further aspect of the invention relates to a modular electronic system or MCM wherein interconnections between elements are non-conductive and, therefore, do not require direct physical contact. The modular system or MCM preferably utilizes the flexibility of the non-conductive junctions to accommodate or dissipate thermal stresses within the system.
- A further aspect of the invention relates to a die, chip or module adapted for assembly in a non-conductively interconnected modular system, and including an externally accessible half-capacitor plate and, preferably, a plurality of electronic devices.
- Yet another aspect of the invention relates to an MCM comprising a plurality of heterogeneous elements, each affixed to a substrate and having means for non-conductively coupling signals to transmission lines or wires in the substrate.
- Still other aspects of the invention relate to means for non-conductively signalling between electronic elements and the use of various dielectric, adhesive, elastomeric and other materials in combination therewith.
- Yet another aspect of the invention relates to a method for increasing the manufacturing yield and reducing the cost of a modular electronic system by assembling high yield known-good units to form a modular system utilizing non-conductive interconnections and, if necessary, to repair or optimize the system by replacing selected elements.
- Further aspects of the invention relate to methods for differentially signalling between elements in a modular system via non-conductive means, and to receiver and transmitter circuits for practicing such signalling methods.
- According to a still further aspect of the invention, very high frequency signals are communicated between modules by transmission line coupling. Such coupling is preferably implemented with parallel or perpendicularly overlapping microstrip or stripline segments. Modular microwave and millimeter wave systems are preferably assembled to communicate via transmission line coupling.
- The above, as well as other, aspects of the invention are explained in the detailed description below, which describes the various preferred embodiments of the invention and is intended to be read in conjunction with the set of figures, in which:
-
FIG. 1 depicts an exemplary portion of one embodiment of a modularelectronic system 1 in accordance with the invention; -
FIG. 2 depicts an exemplary portion of a modular electronic system wherein a signal is differentially coupled from a pair of transmission lines on a substrate, across a pair of coupled half-capacitors, and to a pair of transmission lines on a die; -
FIG. 3 is a partially exploded view of an exemplary portion of a modular electronic system which includes both capacitive and conductive interconnections between a die and a substrate; -
FIG. 4 depicts an exemplary portion of an MCM constructed in accordance with the present invention; -
FIG. 5 depicts an exemplary portion of an MCM similar to that ofFIG. 4 , but including a power substrate, distinct from the signal substrate, as well as a heat sink; -
FIG. 6 depicts exemplary waveforms for a digital (or multi-state) signal capacitively coupled from a die to a substrate in accordance with the invention; -
FIG. 7 depicts an exemplary portion of a modular electronic system in which a die capacitively interconnects (“bridges”) two substrates; -
FIG. 8 depicts an illustrative portion of a non-planar modular electronic system that includes multiple dies and substrates; -
FIG. 9 depicts and exemplary portion of a large-scale modular system constructed in accordance with the invention which utilizes a so-called “leapfrog” geometry; -
FIG. 10 depicts an illustrative portion of a “leapfrog” integrated system constructed entirely from dies; - FIGS. 11A-B depict the effect of misalignment between capacitor plates in a capacitively coupled modular system;
- FIGS. 12A-B depict the use of an oversized half-capacitor plate to minimize the impact of misalignment in a capacitively coupled system;
-
FIG. 13 depicts a modular electronic system wherein a plurality of (optionally superconducting) electronic devices on implemented on a flexible substrate; -
FIG. 14 depicts an illustrative portion of a large-scale, heterogeneously integrated modular electronic system constructed in accordance with the invention; -
FIG. 15 depicts the use of a uniform capacitive interface to couple modules of varying sizes and packaging levels in accordance with the invention; -
FIG. 16 depicts a modular system in which a plurality of modules capacitively couple to a backplane; - FIGS. 18A-C depict several steps in the assembly of an MCM (such as those of
FIGS. 4-5 ) in accordance with the invention; -
FIG. 19 depicts a capacitive signal path including means for adjusting overall gain; - FIGS. 20A-C depict an exemplary application specific module (ASM) constructed in accordance with the invention;
-
FIG. 21 depicts a cable interface utilizing the capacitive coupling techniques of the invention; -
FIG. 22 depicts an exemplary portion of a module electronic system wherein a substrate provides both inter-chip and intra-chip capacitive signal paths; -
FIG. 23A depicts an exemplary apparatus for testing modules constructed in accordance with the invention; -
FIG. 23B depicts a wafer-scale modular system constructed in accordance with the present invention; -
FIGS. 24-25 compare the fabrication of MCMs in the present art (FIG. 24 ) and the fabrication of wafer-scale modules in accordance with the invention (FIG. 25 ); -
FIG. 26 depicts the general flow of assembly, testing and rework of a wafer-scale or similar modular system in accordance with the present invention; -
FIG. 27 shows the yield of good dies in a typical semiconductor fabrication process as a function die size; -
FIG. 28 depicts several plots of system cost as a function of die size for an exemplary capacitively interconnected system; -
FIG. 29 depicts the flow of a design cycle for a modular system constructed in accordance with the present invention; -
FIG. 30 depicts a block diagram of an off-die capacitive signal path in accordance with the invention; - FIGS. 31A-B depict a final stage of a preferred embodiment of a transmitter;
-
FIG. 32 depicts a preferred embodiment of a switching means adapted to drive differential capacitive signal paths; -
FIG. 33 depicts a simplified electrical model of the interface between an exemplary switching means and a terminated substrate transmission line; -
FIG. 34 depicts a simplified electrical model of the interface between an exemplary switching means and an unterminated substrate wiring line; -
FIG. 35 depicts a block diagram of a preferred, differential off-die signal path; -
FIG. 36 is a schematic diagram of an exemplary single-ended receiver compatible for use in the signal path depicted inFIG. 30 ; -
FIG. 37 is a schematic diagram of an exemplary differential receiver compatible for use in the signal path depicted inFIG. 35 ; - FIGS. 38A-B illustrate non-conductive signalling between modules by means of parallel and perpendicular coupled transmission lines.
- Reference is now made to
FIG. 1 , which shows an exemplary portion of one embodiment of a modularelectronic system 1 in accordance with the invention. As depicted,system 1 comprises asubstrate 10, adie 11 and ameans 13 for capacitively signalling, which provides a capacitive signal path betweensubstrate 10 and die 11. Means 13 for capacitively signalling comprises two electromagnetically communicating regions illustratively depicted as “half-capacitors” 14 and 15. A dielectric 17 is preferably used to partly or totally fill the gap between half-capacitors Dielectric 17 may be employed to increase the capacitance of capacitive signalling means 13, to provide passivation fordie 11 orsubstrate 10, to enhance the thermal conductivity betweendie 11 andsubstrate 10, and/or to mechanically bond or supportsubstrate 10 and die 11. - As depicted in
FIG. 1 , die 11 also illustratively includes a plurality ofelectronic devices 12, implemented on an active surface of the die, and a means for powering the die, shown as aconductive contact 16 on the surface of the die. -
Die 11 is preferably a digital integrated circuit fabricated by a conventional, low cost process.System 1 preferably includes additional means for capacitively signalling and additional dies, as depicted in later Figures. For example,system 1 could comprise an MCM. In such a system, die 11 might be a CMOS silicon die withactive components 12 fabricated on its surface, while thesubstrate 10 might be a die fabricated of GaAs. - As will be discussed at length below, use of capacitive signalling means 13 in such a system offers considerable advantages over conventional alternative approaches. Conventional approaches, such as packaging the dies independently and wiring them together conductively, or growing a crystal of one material on a region of the other, are significantly more expensive for comparable performance than comparable systems constructed in accordance with the present invention. Moreover, such conventional systems generally suffer low yields and low operational reliability, due to thermal expansion stresses.
-
Die 11 preferably includes one or moreconductive contacts 16 for powering thedevices 12. For a conventional silicon CMOS die 11, contact 16 illustratively is a metallic aluminum region fabricated lithographically on the silicon CMOS die. In some applications, it may be desirable to gold-plate the outer surface of the aluminum region to protect against corrosion. Illustratively, power could be delivered by means of a metallic fuzz button conductively connected tosubstrate 10 or to a different substrate. Fuzz button power connections, in combination with coupled half-capacitor signal connections substrate 10 non-destructively, which affords significant advantages in terms of testing, repair or performance optimization, as compared to destructive approaches. Such non-destructive mount/remove cycles entail substantially zero forces, torques, or changes in energy across themeans 13 for capacitive signalling. -
Substrate 10 is preferably constructed from a low dielectric factor material in order to facilitate high speed signalling. The substrate can be either passive or active. An example of a passive substrate is a printed wiring board wherein half-capacitor 15 would preferably comprise a lithographically defined copper region ofsubstrate 10. An example of an active substrate is a collection of active and/or passive semiconductor devices and wiring. Typical active elements are set forth below. - Superconducting substrates are particularly well-suited to use coupled half-capacitors, due to the absence of any metallic contact between
die 11 and thesuperconducting substrate 10. Materials problems which might otherwise arise in soldering or bonding to brittle high temperature superconducting ceramic layers are eliminated. All of the propagation advantages of superconducting transmission lines (especially low dispersion) are retained. While termination resistor fabrication is potentially challenging, this can be done with localized heating of a line above the transition temperature, or by application of sufficiently intense DC magnetic fields to force the superconductor normal in the resistive region. Such techniques may also provide a means for tuning the value of the termination resistance in a post-fabrication step by adjusting the current which heats or induces the magnetic field. - Illustratively, half-
capacitors capacitor 14 may comprise an aluminum metal pad lithographically defined on a CMOS silicon integratedcircuit 11. Adequate capacitance can be realized using the upper level of the integrated circuit die metalization to form half-capacitor 14, and a matching plate on ahigh density substrate 10 as the other half-capacitor 15. - Coupled half-capacitors can be formed in arrangements, like 13, which couple one-to-one, or alternatively in structures which couple one-to-many or many-to-many. The circuitry for sending and receiving signals via coupled half-capacitors can advantageously fit underneath or beside the corresponding half-capacitor; the plates themselves therefore need not be lithographed at the expense of usable chip real estate. Using present technology, the invention provides significant advantages in terms of the area required to implement high performance inter-die signalling circuits.
- Coupled half-capacitors are preferably formed by affixing
die 11 tosubstrate 10 such that half-capacitors capacitors - Circuitry for coupled half-capacitors can cost substantially less chip real estate per bit than connections for conductively coupled off-die signalling. The driver and receiver circuits are small enough to be fabricated underneath the corresponding half-capacitor plate. The plates are smaller than contact pads and fan-out leads in the present art, and can overlay other active circuitry, including circuitry unrelated to I/O. Plates can be packed much more densely than pads, and can occupy any part of the surface of the die rather than predominantly the perimeter.
- A coupled half-capacitor of approximately 1 picofarad can be realized with a
plate 70 microns by 70 microns metalized on top of the die, assuming the dielectric factor of the separator is K=112 (TiO2 ceramic) and the plate separation is 3.5 microns. This represents an I/O surface density of approximately 105 equivalent leads per square inch. Alternative dielectric materials, such as oriented barium titanate crystals which have a dielectric factor more than 100 times larger than titanium dioxide, may further increase the I/O density. However, once the half-capacitor plate size becomes smaller than the driver/receiver circuitry, and the die is circuit-limited rather than I/O pad-limited, there is little point in further reducing the size of the plate except in certain scenarios: where they comprise multiple platelet regions ganged together electrically and logically; where they are used for AC powering; or where other surface accessible functions like optical transmitters/detectors compete for surface space. - Standard semiconductor processes allow active circuitry to be implemented beneath a metal half-capacitor plate. In contrast, implementation of active circuitry beneath conductive contact pads is undesirable because mechanical forces imposed on the contact pad can irreversibly alter the electronic behavior of the underlying domain.
- Half-
capacitors - Since the conductance, or charge-carrying capability, of the half-capacitor plates is typically so high, the effective plate-to-plate overlap and separation, and the properties of dielectric 17, largely determine the performance of the coupled half-
capacitors 13. Methods for forming capacitor plates are well-known in the microelectronics industry, although their application to MCMs and other modular interconnection schemes is not recognized in the prior art. - The inter-plate gap between half-
capacitors Dielectric 17 can be disposed between a series of passivation layers on each plate, if any, and intervening insulator, if any. Such passivation layers can be formed cheaply and reliably from oxides of the metalization layer and/or from applied emulsion coatings such as titanium dioxide, crystalline barium titanate oriented along the high-dielectric axis, and other materials which are well-known in the electrochemical community and commercially available. - The known corrosion properties, cleanliness, and viscosity as a function of temperature of the dielectric are crucial, as is its dielectric factor. Colloidal suspensions of high dielectric factor solids (e.g., ceramics like titanium dioxide applied in a slurry) can be used as the filler material, as well as a corrosion-free low dielectric factor liquid, such as the Fluorinerts. The dielectric may be an insulating liquid, such as, ethylene glycol, propylene glycol, glycerin, or nitrobenzene; a gas, such as uranium hexafluoride; or a mixed-phase suspension or gel, in order to exploit heat transport properties, cleanliness, or mechanical stability. The hygroscopic nature of these materials remains a major concern, and some (lower dielectric factor) hydrophobic materials, such as 1,1,1 trichloroethane may therefore be preferable. Hygroscopy and temperature-dependent sensitivity to vibration and to changes in viscosity or dielectric factor complicate implementation, but their treatment is well-known to those skilled in the art. Some processes for applying coatings also require a polishing step.
- Liquid dielectrics may be useful in certain systems, in part because no sheer force is transmitted if the chips have to be moved, and in part because the dielectric is scratch proof. Spacers on the chip surface could assure constant separation in the presence of a high dielectric liquid like glycerol but are not required unless shorting is a risk. In the case of liquid dielectrics, surface tension may be sufficient to hold the die and substrate against one another.
- Intervening insulator(s), if used, should generally slide on at least one side to accommodate thermal expansion, and may either be bonded to one of the dies, substrates or modules, as with an adhesive, or maintained as a monolithic material bonded to neither, such as Cellophane. Bonding to both surfaces should be avoided, except with liquid dielectrics, elastomers, or systems carefully engineered to accommodate thermal expansion.
- Temperature and frequency dependence of the dielectric factor remain a significant engineering consideration. Nearly all known materials exhibit complicated frequency dependence on their dielectric factor, which can effectively limit their range of use in coupled half-capacitor gaps. Of course, dry air or a vacuum represent.exceptions to this rule, but their low dielectric factor and compressibility make them less attractive.
- In the MCM design community, high dielectric materials are shunned in general, since signals propagate through wiring at less than the speed of light by a factor of the square-root of the surrounding dielectric factor. (See, for example, Robert Johnson, Robert Teng, and John Balde, “Multichip Modules Systems Advantages, Major Constructions and Materials Technologies.” IEEE Press, 1991.) Contrary to the teachings in the MCM community, high dielectric materials have a central role in the present invention.
- One disadvantage with high dielectric materials, however, is that they cause the electric field to spread outside the region immediately between opposing half-capacitors, necessitating greater spreading out of the placement of neighboring plates. In this regard, lower dielectric material would allow tighter packing of neighbors, but at the cost of a commensurate increase in voltage or plate area, or a decrease in plate separation, with accompanying complexities. For a system with a uniform dielectric and a plate dimension much greater than the separation, neighboring plates can be packed with a separation approximately twice the vertical separation without encountering significant cross-talk problems. A patterned dielectric, with lowered dielectric factor outside of the gaps between opposing plates, would allow slightly tighter areal packing of plates, but increase the manufacturing complexity. Dielectrics may also be engineered to enable/disable capacitance above a threshold between paired half-capacitors. Extremely low cost processes from the painting/copying industry (e.g., lithography) are well-known for fabricating printed wiring boards, and can analogously be employed to implement the dielectric pattern, effectively defining interconnections.
- While a pair of coupled half-capacitors represents the preferred means for capacitively signalling, other such means are available. For example, multi-storey capacitively coupled structures can be constructed wherein one or more intervening conductive regions are disposed (preferably in the dielectric region) between two terminal half-capacitors, thereby effectively forming a series connected chain of two or more capacitors. Importantly, such multi-layer structures do not require any overlap between the two terminal half-capacitors. For example, in a three-layer structure, overlap only between the bottom plate and a middle conductor and between the top plate and the middle conductor suffices to implement a means for capacitively signalling between the top and bottom plates. Printing/copying processes (e.g., xerography) may be applicable for forming such structures cheaply.
- Reference is now made to
FIG. 2 , which depicts an exemplary portion of a modular electronic system wherein a signal is differentially coupled from a pair oftransmission lines substrate 10, across a pair of coupled half-capacitors 13, to a pair oftransmission lines die 10. A means for terminatingtransmission lines substrate 10 bytermination resistors line 31 a. - Advantageously,
transmission lines active elements 12 ofdie 11.Transmission lines substrate 10, to other chips, modules or substrates via additional coupled half-capacitors, or to external conductive leads.Transmission lines - Reference is now made to
FIG. 3 , which shows a partially exploded view of an exemplary portion of a modular electronic system which includes both capacitive and conductive interconnections betweendie 11 andsubstrate 10.Conductive contact pads substrate 10. Conductive connection is achieved by affixingdie 11 tosubstrate 10 such that conductive connection means 41, 42 and 43 touch theirrespective contacts substrate 10, thereby providing substantial fabrication, testing and repair advantages for modular systems based on the present invention. - Conductive connection means preferably comprise metallic fuzz buttons, such as the Cinapse™ contacts manufactured by Cinch, Inc. The holes in
substrate 10 which accommodatemetallic fuzz buttons substrate 10. Alternative conductive means include solder balls, wiring on tape or films, bonded wires, contact probes, liquid metals such as mercury, low melting point metals such as gallium, and other high conductance media such as may be appropriate for particular engineering situations. - Advantageously, the conductive connections can be customized by impairing (e.g., removing, eroding or destroying) or adding selected fuzz-buttons, thereby disabling or enabling conductive connection between the selected fuzz-buttons and their respective contact pads.
- Typically, the
conductive connections - Contact pads for fuzz buttons occupy 0.3 mm2 each in the preferred embodiment. In contrast, circuitry to drive the capacitive couplings occupies about 0.04 mm2 per half-capacitor, based on a 1 micron CMOS process. Multiply-redundant contact pads may advantageously compensate for the relatively low reliability of mechanical contacts.
- Reference is now made to
FIG. 4 , which depicts an exemplary portion of an MCM constructed in accordance with the present invention. The MCM comprises asubstrate 10, afirst die 11 and asecond die 61. (First die 11 and second die 61 could also represent different parts of a single die.) A terminatedtransmission line 33 interconnects half-capacitors substrate 10, thereby providing a signal path between half-capacitor 14 on thefirst die 11 and half-capacitor 64 on thesecond die 61. -
Transmission line 33 provides efficient communication between half-capacitors transmission line 33, is substantially independent of thelength 51 oftransmission line 33. For communications beyond a reasonably short distance, the off-die route (via transmission line 33) offers potentially superior performance to an equivalent on-die routing of the same signal. By contrast, in prior art MCMs based on conductive signal interconnections between die and substrate, the off-die coupling of signals via the substrate involves substantial performance penalties due to the excessive parasitic inductance of the conductive die/substrate connections. Transmission lines and unterminated wiring both, however, suffer limitations from the integrated net series resistance over a path and the present invention cannot avoid this problem unless a shorter wiring path can be achieved. Modem signal coding techniques such a those discussed below are useful in confining this problem to one of power attenuation rather than signal dispersion. - First die 11 and second die 61 also include
conductive contact pads 52 for, among other things, receiving power fromsubstrate 10. - Advantageously, dies 11 and 61 can be formed from different or incompatible materials. For example, first die 11 could comprise a low cost CMOS integrated circuit while second die 61 could comprise a GaAs integrated circuit, including optical I/O devices. The
spacings different dielectrics substrate 10. - The tolerance of the capacitive interconnections to thermal expansion represents an important advantage of the invention over conventional MCMs. Where dies 11 and 61 represent different portions of a large (e.g., wafer-scale) die, the misalignment errors due to thermal expansion mismatch accrue and can become particularly troublesome. In conductively coupled prior art MCMs, thermal expansion problems often require that the substrate material be selected to match, as closely as possible, the thermal expansion properties of a particular die material, typically silicon. In contrast, the present invention permits integration of heterogeneous dies or modules on a common substrate with substantially relaxed thermal expansion constraints, at least for dies of modest size. To increase the tolerance of the capacitive interconnection between
die 61 andsubstrate 10 to misalignments and/or thermal expansions, half-capacitor 65 is advantageously sized larger than half-capacitor 64. - For large die size, matching the thermal expansion of the
substrate 10 to the thermal expansion of the die becomes a major consideration. Sheer stresses will be induced in the dielectrics unless the large size die and the substrate can slide along their adjacent surfaces or have well matched coefficients of thermal expansion. In addition, unsupported standard wafers bow as much as 50 microns with a 70° C. rise in temperature, suggesting a requirement for edge-to-edge thermal control to within a few degrees Celsius, unless the mating of the substrate, the dielectric, and the large size die is compliant. - Reference is now made to
FIG. 5 , which depicts an exemplary portion of an MCM similar to that ofFIG. 4 , but including apower substrate 70, distinct from thesignal substrate 10, as well as aheat sink 81. -
Power substrate 70 preferably includes aground plane 74,power plane 75 anddecoupling capacitance 79 coupling therebetween. A plurality of terminals represented aselements power substrate 70 are conductively connected to respective terminals on die 11 and provide ground, power and a plurality of external I/O leads, respectively, to die 11. -
Ground plane 74,power plane 75 and the power/ground wiring associated therewith are preferably fabricated using a low resolution lithographic process.Power substrate 70 might alternatively be formed from materials, such as metals, ceramics, organic polymers, silicon, inorganic polymers, glasses, amorphous solids, crystalline solids, polycrystalline solids, composite materials, heterogeneous multilayer materials, or others.Power substrate 70 may be made of rigid or flexible material, depending upon the application, and may include holes or similar patterned features to accommodate, for example, an external optical I/O path 83 from/to an optical I/O device 82 onchip 85. Advantageously, external power, ground and I/O terminals power substrate 70 can be wire-bonded to appropriately configured pins or other external leads, thereby providing aconventional Level 1, 1½, 2, or 3 package lead-out as appropriate. - The conductive connections between
terminals power substrate 70 and similar terminals onchip 11 can be fabricated by reflow-solder, liquid metal or other conductor, metallic fuzz buttons, pin & socket, other mechanically compliant reversible or irreversible contacts, or by wire-bond or other welding techniques. - Alternatively, power could be provided to die 11 or other dies using integrated batteries or high frequency alternating current instead of direct current, thereby dispensing with any requirement for conductively coupled contact points altogether. Use of optical or near-optical frequencies to couple power is preferable since it increases transmission efficiency, and polarizing the radiation decreases crosstalk interference with other signal interconnections, notably including on-chip circuitry. Advantageously, essentially all of a die's surface, except that employed for I/O (e.g., signal coupling half-capacitors, semiconductor lasers, photodetectors and the like), can be used to receive power.
-
FIG. 5 also depicts a means for dissipating heat from dies 11 and 85 comprising aheat sink 81 and athermal elastomer 80 positioned betweenheat sink 81 and dies 11 and 85.Thermal elastomer 80 preferably comprises a material having high thermal conductivity, such as organic elastomers filled with boron nitride. Alternatively, other known methods for effecting good thermal contact between dies 11 and 85 andheat sink 81 can be used, including maintaining the dies and heat sink in intimate physical contact, employing thermally conductive greases or epoxies, soldering or eutectic bonding of the heat sink and dies, and the like. - It ordinarily does not matter whether the thermal elastomer is an electrical insulator or conductor, unless dies operating at different bulk potentials share the same heat sink. But for this or other reasons an electrical insulator may be preferred. Ceramic loaded elastomers containing aluminum oxide or (preferably) boron nitride are one such approach.
-
Heat sink 81 can be cooled with any standard cooling technique, including conductive, convective, or radiative transfer, or by phase change of a suitable material, as in a heat pipe. - Preferably,
heat sink 81 also comprises apressure plate 84.Force 84 applied throughpressure plate 81 assures intimate contact between dies 11 and 85 andsubstrates heat sink 81. Positioning the dies and substrates relative to one another by means of pressure offers important advantages with respect to building and unbuilding the MCM assembly reversibly (e.g., for repair, inspection, testing, performance enhancement, and so forth). Advantageously, use of areformable elastomer 80 further contributes to these reversibility advantages. - If two
distinct substrates substrates - Construction of the interconnects on
signal substrate 10 is extremely rapid and amenable to mass production. The signal lines insubstrate 10 may advantageously be fabricated as microstrips, striplines or slotlines. In general, more layers will be required onsubstrate 10 as the size of substrate 10 (and the number of or size of die(s)) grows to compensate for the typical geometric increase in wire density. Advantageously, the superior electrical characteristics of the lithographically formed transmission lines onsubstrate 10 allows use of longer-than-minimal routing paths in order to relieve layout wiring congestion. Assuming that the resistors terminating a transmission line are lithographically fabricated, the cost ofmanufacturing substrate 10 is approximately linear as a function of area or at worst is a slowly growing geometric function. Importantly, the manufacturing cost is not proportional to the number of signal interconnections between substrate and die(s), as is the case for the many conventional contact junctions needed for conductive signalling. The cost of the remaining components-power substrate 70,heat sink 81,pressure plate 84, andthermal elastomer layer 80—scale approximately linearly with area, also independent of the number of die/substrate signal interconnections. -
FIG. 5 also shows two exemplary passivation layer configurations for dies 11 and 85. Passivation layer 86 (covering die 11) and layer 87 (covering die 85) are preferably thin, protective layers of silicon dioxide, silicon nitride, polyimide, borosilicate glass or similar materials. Illustratively,passivation layer 87 covers the entire active surface ofdie 85, whilepassivation layer 86 is patterned and does not cover half-capacitor plate 14. Common passivation materials have significantly lower dielectric factors than many of the materials contemplated for use in the preferred embodiment ofdielectric 17. Accordingly, the passivation materials preferably should not be used on the half-capacitor plates and, if used, should have as high dielectric factors as practical. -
Passivation layer 86 is patterned by lithographically defining regions of the passivation layer to be removed during the chip fabrication process, then selectively removing such regions. Advantageously, the lithographically defined region can be smaller than the half-capacitor plate, so as to provide a border region surrounding the half-capacitor wherein the passivation layer partially overlaps the plate. With only a portion of the half-capacitor plate 14 exposed without passivation, the influx of chemical contaminants is effectively discouraged. - In contrast,
passivation layer 87 covers half-capacitor plate 64. This approach typically reduces the available capacitance of the coupled half-capacitors, but eliminates possible contamination problems at the exposed plate boundary. - In either passivation layer configuration, the
conductive contacts 52 will be unpassivated, as in current fabrication technologies. Advantageously, noble metal contacts may be useful for avoiding oxidation or corrosion. -
FIG. 5 also illustrates why manufacturing and construction of a modular system in accordance with the invention is simpler than current techniques for forming a modular system with a comparable number of signal interconnections and similar density. The exemplary fabrication of half-capacitor plates and passivation layers employs standard semiconductor fabrication techniques, and the dielectric can itself be the adhesive holding the modular system together, while the heat sink and thermal elastomer are largely standard components. Similarly, the substrate (and power substrate, if employed) can be easily mass-produced with current techniques. While some changes will be required in the CAD layout tools, the flexibility to locate half-capacitor interconnect plates directly above other signal lines on the dies simplifies the layout problem. - Reliability of the interconnects is extremely high if the
FIG. 5 embodiment is employed. Fuzz buttons are comparable to pressed gold wires and TAB in assuring reliable electrical contact, although neither is as mechanically robust as solder or a lithographed metal junction. Fuzz buttons are at present, however, the easiest and most reliable of those conductive contact means to handle through repair/replacement cycles. The plurality of means for capacitively signalling avoids, by design, significant amounts of thermally induced sheer stress, assuming the dielectric is properly selected. In any case, the heat stress and forces perpendicular to the surface will likely be significantly lower than in conventional modular systems in which conductive bonds are pushed or soldered together. - Using capacitive couplings for signalling means that many fewer conductive contacts are needed (e.g., only for power, ground, or off-module I/O). Therefore, the Poisson statistics for anticipating failure need only account for a fraction of the number of mechanical components, as compared to conductively coupled signalling systems. Generally, important failure modes in MCM-level modular systems include solder deformities, electromigration, and metal-metal corrosion. Typical processes for assembling MCMs involve repeated installation and removal of dies from the module. During these steps, failure modes associated with the conductive connections to dies represent the dominant factor diminishing the yield or reliability of the manufacturing process. Such yield loss correlates strongly with the number of conductive connections. Therefore, the present invention, which employs dramatically fewer conductive connections than conventional MCM technologies, enjoys considerable advantages in terms of manufacturing/assembling yield, reliability, reparability and cost. These simplifications also benefit the design and operating cycles.
- Reference is now made to FIGS. 6A-D, which depict exemplary waveforms for a 3-state digital signal coupled from die 11 to die 85 of
FIG. 5 and appropriately supported by 3-state logic. -
FIG. 6A shows a typical digital waveform in a high speed digital system. The waveform consists of a series of states, the states being defined by the level of the waveform during aparticular clock period 29. For example, duringperiod 21, the waveform represents a digital “1”. Inperiod 22, it represents a digital “0”. In the case of a 3-state system, the waveform duringperiod 23 represents a state designated “−1”. The waveform is generated by a digital circuit constructed fromdevices 12 ondie 11. - Before transmission across capacitative signalling means 13, a transmitter circuit on die 11 converts the digital waveform of
FIG. 6A into a pulsed waveform as depicted inFIG. 6B . Note that in this example, the 3-state transmitter suppresses the trailing edge transition, which a 2-state (binary) transmitter advantageously would not bother doing. The exemplary pulsed waveform generated by the transmitter includes apulse 24 representing the logic state during a particular portion of the clock period. The pulsed waveform is applied to half-capacitor 14, from which it travels to half-capacitor 64 by way of a first half-capacitor 15, terminatedtransmission line 33, and second half-capacitor 65 onsubstrate 10. -
FIG. 6C shows the pulsed waveform received on half-capacitor 64, lagged in time due to the finite speed of transmission over the electrical distance from half-capacitor 14, and attenuated by the non-zero series impedance of the electrical path. At high speeds, the transmission of pulsed waveforms between half-capacitor plates - The signal received by half-
capacitor 64 is coupled to a receiver circuit ondie 85. This receiver circuit generates the digital output signal depicted inFIG. 6D . Note that in this example, the 3-state receiver has timing circuitry or access to a clock signal, so can discern and restore “0” states 22 as well as the trailing edges suppressed by the transmitter. As is apparent, the waveform ofFIG. 6D represents a delayed and restored version of the original digital input waveform depicted inFIG. 6A . - The waveforms shown in FIGS. 6A-D are merely exemplary. A myriad of signalling schemes are possible, many of which are preferred over the simple, un-encoded, 3-state single-ended scheme depicted in FIGS. 6A-D. In particular, differential binary signalling offers significant advantages in terms of noise immunity.
- The signalling across coupled half-capacitors need not utilize the pulsed digital mode depicted in FIGS. 6A-D, but can instead employ any modulation of some combination of phase, frequency, amplitude and/or signal-to-noise ratio. The signals can have any form that does not require coupling of the DC component across the coupled half-capacitor. The signals may comprise binary or multistate codings, and, in the case of a ganged half-capacitor junction, may represent a multibit encoding encompassing the signals from one or more half-capacitors as channels.
- The presently preferred embodiment employs pulses, each representing a bit, which are sent across a “differential pair” of coupled half-capacitor junctions. This is essentially a binary differential version of the technique illustrated in FIGS. 6A-D. Many of the telecommunication industry's techniques for communicating digital information over bandwidth-limited communication links have no DC component, and thus are advantageous in connection with the present invention. Notable such methods include alternate mark inverse and 10B8 codes. In addition, any coding scheme based on (approximately) constant numbers of zero & one bits, such as Knuth's methods, will have particularly advantageous signal-to-noise properties for a given power budget. Modem techniques designed for limited bandwidth environments, including frequency key shifting, phase encoding, and amplitude coding, are also useful as are hybrid coding schemes, such as QPSK. Multidimensional sphere packing, Reed-Solomon codes, Trellis codes, or other algorithms for coding states across one or more signal channels can be used to maximize inter-chip signalling bandwidth, up to the Shannon limit for the system, which may be higher than the clock rate. Of special interest is the class of coding schemes with limited bandwidth, since they can be used to transmit signals through exponentially tapered stripline transmission line transformers, allowing the matching of signals with high voltage swing but low current to low impedance transmission lines as part of the coupled half-capacitor Limiting the bandwidth can advantageously avoid difficulties arising from dispersive lines. Major causes of such dispersion include the frequency-dependence of the line's dielectric factor, frequency dependent dielectric losses, skin effect and losses from the source resistance.
- Reference is now made to
FIG. 7 , which depicts an exemplary portion of a modular electronic system in which a die bridges two substrates. Bridging die 89 includes at least two half-capacitors 14 a-b, each of which couples to half-capacitors 15 a-b ondifferent substrates 10 a-b viadielectrics 17 a-b. Bridging die 89 preferably includes a plurality of active electronic devices implemented on anactive surface 12 thereof.Substrates capacitors 14 a-b and 15 a-b are advantageously sized to accommodate anticipated thermal expansion and/or mechanical misalignment. - Either a passive or active signal path on bridging
die 89 connects half-capacitors substrates - Bridging die 89 preferably comprises a part of a very large system wherein a multiplicity of substrates are tied together with bridging modules, in this example a die. Systems formed from a multiplicity of substrates bearing microelectronic devices and/or wiring need not be primarily planar like those depicted in
FIGS. 5 and 7 , and can be extremely large: Barn Door Scale Integration is possible using the invention.FIGS. 9, 10 , and 13 extend the teaching to exemplary extensible non-planar and planar arrangements. - Buckling modes may arise at the edges overlapped by bridging modules, particularly in vibration-rich environments. Such bending or expansion modes may effectively limit the diameter of buildable systems. Fortunately, these issues are well-understood by practitioners, and can be ameliorated in the preferred embodiment by a combination of compliant, mechanically damping dielectric or mounting materials, and use of compensatingly larger half-capacitors and circuit thresholds near the affected regions.
- Reference is now made to
FIG. 8 , which depicts an illustrative portion of a modular electronic system that includes multiple dies 11, 92, 95 andsubstrates FIG. 8 , die 11 is capacitively coupled tosubstrate 10. Note that the multi-storey structure of the capacitive signalpath coupling chip 11 to substrate 10 (by way ofconductor 14 y, illustratively depicted as having been fabricated monolithically amidstdielectrics 17 x and 17 y) creates an “effective overlap” between half-capacitors 14 x and 15 x, which are not “substantially overlapped” plates. Substantially overlapped half-capacitors, such as 94 a and 15, are effectively overlapped ipso facto. -
Substrate 10 is also capacitively coupled tosubstrate 90. Withinsubstrate 90, wiring 91 connects a plurality of half-compactiors 94 a to a plurality of half-capacitors 94 b, thereby providing an AC signal path betweensubstrate 10 andsubstrate 93 and betweensubstrate 10 and die 92.Substrate 93 also connects conductively to die 95 via a plurality of conductive leads 97, bonded to a plurality ofconductive pads 96 onsubstrate 93. - Illustratively,
substrate 10 may comprise a printed wiring board, whilesubstrate 90 may comprise a multilayer ceramic substrate.Substrate 93 may be encapsulated within aplastic carrier package 98, which package also advantageously encapsulates die 95.Modules - Those ordinarily skilled in the art will recognize numerous alternative arrangements of single or multiple dies coupled to or between single or multiple substrates by means of the invention. Such alternative arrangements are advantageously selected to accommodate particular physical, mechanical, electrical, thermal, and economic constraints of a particular system application. The distribution and costs of all components—on dies or substrates, as higher level modules of them, the thermal and environmental systems, the mechanical chassis, and so forth—can be considered in the overall system-wide Level 0-4 package optimization. For example, a substrate bearing capacitive contacts at right angles to the interconnection orientation may facilitate construction of
Level 3 packages akin to backplanes or card cages, as inFIG. 16 , and the given form factor may therefore influence the choice of circuitry in detail and assignment of circuits to modules. Flexible or articulated substrates may be used to further extend the number of feasible physical arrangements. Abutting or partially overlapping substrates may be used to couple signals, clocks, etc. throughout a large system, as inFIGS. 9-10 . Using means for capacitive coupling to link regions bearing powered microelectronic devices to others or to substrates bearing wiring, numerous alternative regular or irregular topologies follow obviously from the present invention, including tilings, lattices, or cluster configurations. Arrangements of organized congregations of such regions, such as modular ensembles of dies and/or substrates, likewise follow directly from the invention. To the extent that such alternative system arrangements employ various claimed aspects of the invention, such arrangements shall be considered within the scope of the present invention. - Reference is now made to
FIG. 9 , which depicts an exemplary portion of a large-scale modular system constructed in accordance with the invention.FIG. 9 illustrates a so-called “leapfrog” geometry: Signals “leap” from a first module to a second via a bridging module which partially overlaps the first and second modules. Using this leapfrog assembly technique, large-scale systems can be constructed very economically. - In
FIG. 9 , a portion ofdie 115overlaps substrate 123 such that half-capacitors substrate 123 and die 115. The leapfrog arrangement continues withsubstrate 124, which partially overlaps and capacitively couples to die 115 via coupled half-capacitors substrate 140 partially overlaps and capacitively couples withsubstrate 124, thus extending the leapfrog configuration. Advantageously, the leapfrog technique can also be used to distribute power from one die/substrate to the next through, for example, the previously mentioned fuzz-button connections. - Also depicted in
FIG. 9 is a non-bridging die 119 (not part of the leapfrog arrangement) having a plurality of active devices and coupled tosubstrate 124 via a plurality of coupled half-capacitors 117. Similarly, non-bridging die 136 illustratively employs an off-die signal path (in substrate 140) to couple circuits onactive surface 138 proximate to half-capacitors - Several advantages of the leapfrog geometry are worth noting. First, the negative effects of thermal expansion are greatly reduced as compared, for example, to a similarly sized system in which a single substrate and die mate. Thus, if die 115 runs very hot and causes a slight misalignment of half-
capacitors capacitors capacitors - Another advantage of the leapfrog configuration is its easy reparability. The
top level modules bottom modules - Still another advantage of the leapfrog configuration is the high performance of its inter-die connections. As previously noted, coupled half-capacitors (or coupled transmission lines) have lower parasitic inductance than similarly sized conductive connections. Additionally, since the modules in the leapfrog configuration overlap, the lengths of signal paths will be shorter than, for example, conventional technologies which utilize peripherally distributed pins, such as PC boards or MCMs with surface mounted dies. The combination of shorter signal paths and lower parasitic inductances can lead to a substantial increase in overall system performance.
- The leapfrog configuration can also be denser than conventional planar packaging techniques. Therefore, clock skew problems are significantly mitigated. Advantageously, a clock signal can be broadcast, preferably from a centrally located module in a leapfrog integrated system, via a plurality of clock distribution paths, each of which comprises one or more transmission line segments linked by coupled half-capacitors. Such clock distribution paths preferably do not include restoring logic (e.g., transmitter and/or receiver circuits) and thus avoid introducing unnecessary gate delays into the clock signal.
- In conventional MCM systems, great effort is expended to reduce the dielectric factor of the substrate material, since the speed of signal propagation scales inversely with the square root of the dielectric factor. Advantageously, the leapfrog configuration of the present invention reduces the lengths of signal paths, which provides a linear improvement in signal propagation time. Accordingly, low latency can be achieved using the invention without need for exotic, low dielectric factor substrates.
- A further advantage of the leapfrog configuration is that it enables integration of heterogeneous, incompatible modules. The voltage levels, materials, etc. can be different among semiconductor die 115, die 119, and die 136, thereby permitting a system designer to exploit the particular advantages of various technologies within a densely integrated system. Likewise, the properties of
substrates substrate 123 might be a laminate material such as FR4,substrate 124 might be an active substrate formed with a thin-film such as lines lithographed onto a chips-first plane, andsubstrate 140 might be a thick-film fabricated xerographically. - The cheapness of interconnect and amenability to heterogeneous integration means that small dies or modules may be used to support partial or specialized functions. Conventional technology, in contrast, generally attempts to bundle multiple functional subsystems into large-scale integrated circuits due to the cost of off-die signalling, often compounding manufacturing costs and sacrificing performance (due to use of suboptimal technologies for particular components, e.g., analog, etc.). Some important examples of components which a capacitively coupled multichip system might carry include logic devices (e.g., Field Programmable Logic Arrays), (field-programmable) gate arrays, processors, arithmetic units, bitwise manipulation units (e.g., cellular automata), permutation units, interconnection networks, memory, nanomechanical actuators, sensors, arrays of fractional analog or digital components (e.g., resistors of various sizes), or others.
- Reference is now made to
FIG. 10 , which depicts an illustrative portion of a leapfrog integrated system constructed entirely from dies. Advantageously, replacement ofsubstrates FIG. 9 ) with dies 163, 164 and 180 permits denser integration of logic and other circuits, as well as perfect matching of thermal coefficients of expansion. Otherwise, the properties and advantages of theFIG. 10 die-die-die leapfrog configuration are analogous to those of theFIG. 9 die-substrate-die leapfrog assembly orFIG. 7 substrate-die-substrate assembly, and therefore need not be reiterated. Power is advantageously delivered through the interstices between dies in such a system, rather than through either perforations or diffused contacts through dies, and may advantageously employ a dedicated power substrate and pressure plate. - Reference is now made to
FIGS. 11 a-b, which depict the effect of misalignment between capacitor plates in a capacitively coupled modular system.FIG. 11 a shows a portion of a capacitively coupled system wherein dies 251, 252, 253 and 254 are perfectly aligned so as to define overlappingregions -
FIG. 11 b shows the same portion wherein die 252 (ofFIG. 11 a) has been replaced by amisaligned die 262. The misalignment ofdie 262 decreases the area ofregions die 262 and dies 251 and 253 will diminish; crosstalk betweendie 262's half-capacitors and other proximate conductive signal lines or half-capacitors may increase as well. Importantly, however, the misalignment ofdie 262 does not affect the coupling or alignment between other dies not directly coupled to 262, for example, die 254. - If misalignment of particular dies can be anticipated (e.g., the dies run very hot) the size of the half-capacitors associated with those particular dies can be advantageously increased to compensate. Importantly, only those particular half-capacitors associated with the troublesome dies need be enlarged. Therefore, there is no significant decrease in the overall density of off-die connections in the system. The low cost or inherent tolerance to misalignment of coupled half-capacitor junctions makes these junctions useful in many different applications, not just in multichip modules. For example, cables utilizing half-capacitor connections potentially provide cost, reliability, size and performance advantages over conventional cables (See
FIG. 21 ). Likewise, high pin-count modular consumer products, such as dockable laptop computers, will realize similar benefits by use of the invention. Pad-limited chips in general can advantageously be implemented using the invention. Notable such chips typically compose signal routing networks, binary integrated circuits whose size is limited by the number of permissible simultaneous 1-0 or 0-1 transitions, and many very small chips. - Reference is now made to
FIGS. 12 a-b, which depict the use of an oversized half-capacitor plate to minimize the impact of misalignment. InFIGS. 12 a-b, half-capacitor 272 is intentionally made larger than half-capacitor 273. This allows die 274 to expand substantially (as depicted inFIG. 12 b) without affecting the area of half-capacitor plate overlap (i.e. 270 versus 271). - Another use for an oversized half-capacitor plate such as 272 is to terminate some of the fringing field lines from the smaller half-
capacitor plate 273 which would otherwise terminate on other nearby structures. This advantageously reduces the amount of crosstalk received by the smaller half-capacitor plate 273. - Reference is now made to
FIG. 13 , which depicts an exemplary portion of a heterogeneously integrated system and illustrates various techniques for integrating modules in accordance with the invention. - The system of
FIG. 13 illustratively depicts two hierarchical levels arranged in a substantially space-filling package. However, the integration techniques exemplified therein are extensible systems utilizing deeper levels of hierarchical encapsulation in 2D or 3D. The system comprisesmodules Module 200 comprises capacitively coupledchips Module 211 comprises capacitively coupledchips Module 219 comprises capacitively coupledchips -
FIG. 13 exemplifies a variety of means for couplingmodules Cable 214 conductively couples chip 204 ofmodule 200 to chip 208 ofmodule 211. A capacitive signal path is provided betweenchip 202 ofmodule 200 andchip 210 ofmodule 211 via half-capacitor 203, half-capacitor 205,interconnection substrate 206, half-capacitor 207 and half-capacitor 209. - The mounting of
chips module 219 is angled against aspacer 212 to accommodate an illustratively depicted externally imposed form factor requirement.Flexible interconnection substrate 216 completes acapacitive signal path 217 betweenchip 208 ofmodule 211 andchip 215 ofmodule 219, and is preferably fabricated from a flexible material so as to accommodate non-planer form factor constraints.Chip 215 ofmodule 219 receives further input from external conductive oroptical connection 218. - Although depicted in partially exploded view, it is apparent that the partial system depicted in
FIG. 13 makes up a substantially space filling assembly. Thus, the space filling assembly depicted onFIG. 13 may itself be a modular part of a larger modular electronic system. Systems implemented in volumetrically dense 3D space filling packages generally have shorter average path lengths and faster clock rates than 2D implementations. - Heat sinks are not explicitly shown in
FIG. 13 , but may be easily positioned as disclosed elsewhere herein.Spacer 212, in addition to providing mechanical support to meet externally imposed form factor requirements, also advantageously conducts heat away fromchips - Reference is now made to
FIG. 14 , which depicts an embodiment of the invention wherein a plurality of optionally superconducting devices are implemented as a layer on a flexible or contoured substrate. Prefabricated die 231 and 239, each bearing a plurality of microelectronic devices, are affixed to opposing faces of asingle substrate 230. Capacitive signalling betweendie capacitors substrate 230 and advantageously need not be planar. - When material constraints permit, both the microelectronic devices and the half-capacitors are advantageously implemented in
substrate 230 by monolithic fabrication techniques. For example, regions of material may be deposited ontosubstrate 230 or otherwise processed into it (e.g., by ion implantation). Advantageously, Josephson Junction devices may be implemented in a (preferably high-Tc) superconducting thin film painted or otherwise deposited ontosubstrate 230. -
Substrate 230 is contoured so as to provide adequate capacitive coupling between half-capacitors substrate 230, such as spirals or coaxial cylindrical shapes, may also be used. - Dies 231 and 239, as well as half-
capacitors optical sensor 240 andpower contact pad 241 are preferably fabricated prior to deformation ofsubstrate 230.Substrate 230 may be formed either from two or more distinct pieces bonded or otherwise melded during manufacture, from a flexible material, or from a single piece of rigid material deformed during manufacture by heat or other appropriate treatment. - Power and ground may be provided to the devices by conductive or radiative contact to
power pad 241, or by on-board batteries. Advantageously, particularly in superconducting systems, AC powering means 235 may communicate power to pad 241 without need for mechanical contact. - External signalling is advantageously provided by a
lightpipe 234 optically coupled, throughdielectric 237, to an optical sensor (or driver) 240. Alternatively, capacitive or magnetic means, as detailed elsewhere herein, may be used. - Reference is now made to
FIG. 15 , which depicts the use of a uniform capacitive interface to couple modules of varying sizes and packaging levels. InFIG. 15 , the use of auniform capacitive interface 276 onmodule 274 and auniform capacitive interface 275 on modules 277 a-c permits interchangeable connection of modules 277 a-c tomodule 274. -
Capacitive interfaces capacitive interface 276 may more half-capacitors than are coupled tointerface 275, the additional half-capacitors oninterface 276 being used to accommodate coupling to test-modules, engineering changes, etc. - In
FIG. 15 , alternatively connectable modules 277 a-c illustratively represent different levels in the packaging hierarchy:module 277 a illustratively comprises a Level-0 unpackaged die;module 277 b illustratively comprises a Level-2 packaged module; and,module 277 c illustratively comprises a Level-2 or Level-3 packaged module. - The use of standard
capacitive interfaces modules module 277 a) and installed into the product without need for any higher-level system modifications. Other sequences of product evolution, such as replacement ofmodule 277 c with 277 b or replacement of either with a Level 1½ MCM implementation, are also possible within the scope of the present invention. - To illustrate the system evolution aspect of the present invention, one may view modules 277 a-c as different implementations of a functional block of a massively parallel computer. Depending on the requirements of a particular application, the computer manufacturer could alternatively install a
low performance module 277 a, amedium performance module 277 b, or ahigh performance module 277 c. Similarly, such functional modules can be advantageously upgraded as the overall requirements of a particular system in the field evolves. - A pervasive problem in hierarchically decomposing a design in the prior art encompasses the partitioning of high level functions, followed by the discovery that a low level module cannot be implemented effectively in a given technology, followed by the need to repartition at a high level again to avoid the suboptimal (e.g., very expensive) technology mix. Underlying both the improved product evolution and system evolution provided by the invention is the fact that the invention permits implementation of common dense, high performance interfaces uniformly to all the levels in the packaging hierarchy. The hierarchical decomposition design process can exploit a uniform interface and functional specifications for each submodule in accordance with the invention. The invention's support for common interfaces assures that a submodule specified early can be implemented late in the process, even if multiple dies or different technologies are needed to accomplish the function. Thus, the invention greatly enhances a designer's ability to exploit hierarchical decomposition, since the implementation of particular modules in a hierarchical system is not necessarily constrained by the interfaces between modules. If, as the implementation proceeds, the anticipated technology proves inappropriate for implementing a submodule, an alternative technology or MCM can generally be substituted without reworking higher-order partitions.
- Reference is now made to
FIG. 16 , which depicts a modular system in which a plurality of modules capacitively couple to a substrate mounted to a supporting chassis, illustratively depicted as a backplane.Substrate 278 comprises the backplane and includes a plurality of module mounting supports 279 a-c. Supports 279 a-c are preferably fabricated from a material of high thermal conductivity, so as to enhance heat dissipation from themodules 280 a affixed thereto. Eachbackplane slot 281 preferably accommodates amodular subsystem 282, illustratively mounted onsupport 279 a and depicted in an exploded view adjacent to support 279 b. -
Modular subsystem 282 includes a plurality of dies 280 a-b and a bridgingsubstrate 280 c.Die 280 a capacitively interconnects to die 280 b. Conductive power connections are not shown; these can be implemented as shown inFIGS. 4-6 . Bridging substrate provides a capacitive signal path between die 280 a andsubstrate 278.Substrate 278 preferably includes a plurality of terminated transmission lines (not depicted, but generally as shown inFIG. 5 ) which interconnect the variousmodular subsystems 282. - Reference is now made to
FIG. 17A , which depicts a perspective of a prior art face-up level 1 package. Asingle die 289 m, typically formed of silicon, is supported by asubstrate 289 n, typically formed of an epoxy or ceramic material. A plurality of power leads 289 g and signal leads 289 e are typically formed from aluminum struts. Power leads 289 g conductively contact power/ground contact pads 289 i via wire-bonds 289 h; ground andpower rails 289 k distribute voltage to circuits implemented ondie 289 m. Signal leads 288 e conductively couple to I/O circuitry 288 a by means of low-resistance fan-out 288 b,contact pads 288 c, and wire-bonds 288 d. -
FIG. 17A illustrates a fundamental disadvantage of the prior art: useful real estate ondie 289 m is wasted to support conductive signalling to other chips and/or other package levels. InFIG. 17A , such real estate for signalling includescontact pads 288 c, low-resistance fan-out 288 b to the pads, and drivers/receivers 288 a. In addition to the costs of excess real estate utilization, the prior art also requiresbond wires 288 d and the package itself 288 n. Ifpads 288 c are limited to the periphery of the die 289 m (thereby shortening fan-outs 288 b), additional real estate may be needed to provide enough perimeter area to accommodate the pads. Thus, designs requiring a high density of I/O terminals further increase the fraction wasted chip real estate. Finally, the presence ofsubstrate 289 n increases the size of the overall package assembly to many times of that thebare die 289 m. -
FIG. 17A also depicts some of the sources of reliability and performance problems commonly encountered in the prior art. The series inductance of acontact junction 288 b-288 c andbond lead 288 d is typically very high (e.g., 0.05-10 nH), and serves as a low pass filter, thereby necessitating more power to drive signal lines at higher clock rates. Conductive contacts are large relative to logic gates, and do not scale desirably as clock rates increase and lithographic dimensions decrease. Finally, conductive contact junctions entail mechanical contact, thereby limiting ability to assemble and disassemble the connections to die 289 m and decreasing the reliability of such connections. - Reference is now made to
FIG. 17B which depicts an exploded view of illustrative flip-chip Level 1 modular system implemented in accordance with the present invention.Substrate 289 f mates withdie 289 e, and advantageously provides signallinginterconnections 289 b, preferably implemented as terminated transmission lines. Power/ground contact pads 289 i mate reversibly withconductive fuzz buttons 289 c so as to provide a reversible conductive interconnection betweensubstrate 289 f and die 289 e. Alternatively,substrate 289 f can be adapted such thatcontact pads 289 i mate with conventional conductive contacting means, such as solder bumps, wire-bonds, pins or ball grid arrays. Fan-outs 289 k distribute power to various circuits implemented ondie 289 e. One or more drivers and/orreceivers 288 a, preferably utilizing pulse signalling and implemented underneath half-capacitor plates 289 a, signal between matched half-capacitor plates 289 a-aa across a gap. The gap is preferably filled with a material having a high die electric factor. - Comparing the illustrative single-die system of the invention (
FIG. 17B ) to the typical single-die system of the prior art (FIG. 17A ), it is apparent that the invention frees up most of the real estate devoted to fan-outs 288 b andcontact pads 288 c, making this area available for the implementation of useful circuitry inFIG. 17B . Further, the invention eliminates the costs associated with elements withbond wires 288 e and external signal leads 288 d; and the cost for the conductivepower contact pads 289 c in the invention is likely to be less than the sum of the costs ofpower bond wires 289 g and leads 289 h in the prior art. - The cost per square inch of substrate of 289 f and the associated dielectric is roughly comparable to that of substrate of 289 n. However, since
substrate 289 n is likely to be smaller thansubstrate 289 f, the invention provides reduced substrate cost as well. Since the system of the invention (FIG. 17B ) is generally denser than the prior art system (FIG. 17A ) the invention will require shorter signal lines, thereby decreasing latency and attenuation loss. - Certain prior art flip-chip technologies, such as solder bump, avoid the real estate needed for
bond wires 288 b and leads 288 c. However, such prior art technologies still introduce the undesirable series inductance associated with conductive interconnections. Moreover, the small size of coupled half-capacitor junctions allows large numbers of junctions to be fabricated cheaply, densely and at high yield. Further, the simple mating process provided by the invention allows assembly of the die into MCMs at the foundry, thus avoiding the need to ship die elsewhere in order to manufacture MCMs or boards. - Reference is now made to FIGS. 18A-C, which depict several steps in the assembly of an MCM (such as those of
FIGS. 4-5 ) in accordance with the invention. While a number of methods could be used, FIGS. 18A-C illustrate an approach which uses a vacuum hold-down during assembly. - Referring now to
FIG. 18A , a plurality ofdie 503 are aligned with ahigh resolution substrate 503, coated with a dielectric 502, using optical feedback and fiducial marks on both die and substrate. Such fiducials can be tracked through holes in the substrate under the die, or by infra-red imaging through silicon wafers. Registration of thedie 503 can be verified, and alignment refined, by measuring and maximizing the capacitance between selected pairs of die and substrate half-capacitors. Interferometry by the pick'n'place apparatus may also be used. - Once all die are aligned, a vacuum is drawn under
substrate 501—byvacuum chamber 505,vacuum hose attachment 506 and O-ring 504—so as to hold the die 503 firmly in place. - Referring now to
FIG. 18B , an elastomericthermal conductor 511 and pressure plate/heat sink 510 are then positioned and locked into contact with the back side of thedie 503 bybolts 512 andnuts 513, thereby forming a rigid assembly. - Referring now to
FIG. 18C , the rigid assembly is inverted andconductive contacts 521 are placed into thehigh resolution substrate 501. Thepower substrate 520 is placed over the contacts. Assembly of the module is completed by compression of the power substrate against the pressureplate using bolts 522 and nuts 523. - An advantageous alternative assembly technique involves the use of ultra-violet curable adhesives. In this method, the substrate is coated with a dielectric material, a UV curable adhesive is applied, the die are then individually positioned and aligned, and UV radiation is applied to cure the adhesive.
- Reference is now made to
FIG. 19 , which depicts a capacitive signal path including means for adjusting overall gain. The need for gain adjustment may arise from a number of factors, including lateral and/or angular misalignments of the half-capacitor plates (from construction or thermal expansion), processing variations affecting transmitters or receivers, variations or non-linearities in the dielectric, and so forth. - On
module 286,transmitter 286 a, in response to an input signal onsignal line 286 b, generates signals on half-capacitor 286 c. Onmodule 287,receiver 287 a, in response to the signals received at half-capacitor 287, generates an output signal onsignal line 287 b. -
FIG. 19 depicts several means for adjusting the overall gain of the capacitively coupled signal path in order to optimize the signal-to-noise ratio betweeninput 286 b andoutput 287 b: (1) the gain oftransmitter 286 a may be adjusted; (2) a trim plate (a/k/a “platelet” 286 d may be ganged in parallel with or disconnected from half-capacitor 286 c; (3)trim plates 287 d-dd may be ganged in parallel with or disconnected from half-capacitor 287; and/or, the gain ofreceiver 287 a may be adjusted. - Transmitter configuration means 286 e controls the gain of
transmitter 286 a and/or the connections betweentrim plate 286 d and half-capacitor 286 c. Similarly, receiver configuration means 287 e controls the gain ofreceiver 287 a and/or the connections betweentrim plates 287 d-dd and half-capacitor 287 c. The use of such configuration means generalizes easily to differential signal paths as well. - Adjustment of capacitive signal path gain can be either static or dynamic. Static adjustment is preferably performed prior to assembly (i.e., mating of 286 and 287) and compensates for variances in the manufacture of dies 286 and 287. The goal is to avoid a situation in which a particularly weak transmitter is paired with a particularly weak receiver. Static adjustment of
die 286 involves temporarily affixing die 286 to a well characterized test die. The test die receives pulses fromdie 286 and provides feedback used to program transmitter configuration means 286 e, thereby configuring the gain oftransmitter 286 a within the ordinary tolerance. Static adjustment ofdie 287 involves an analogous procedure wherein a temporarily affixed test die applies well characterized pulses to die 287, so as to enable appropriate programming of receiver configuration means 287 e. - Dynamic configuration compensates for gain variances that arise either during manufacture of
modules - Information may advantageously be relayed among configuration means 286 e and 287 e, and devices in the larger system. The larger system preferably provides storage means, analysis & data reduction means, diagnostic means, and reporting & auditing means, as well as other services. Preferably, the larger system may co-optimize the settings in configuration means 286 e and 287 e together, advantageously as a function of data from both, advantageously including sensory data.
- Reference is now made to FIGS. 20A-B, which depict an exemplary application specific module (ASM) constructed from application specific submodules (ASSMs) in accordance with the invention. As is well known, advances in CAD technology have precipitated explosive growth in the use of application specific integrated circuits (ASICs) wherein a stored description of a system is implemented automatically by CAD system customization of an integrated circuit mask, and the mask is then fabricated and packaged in a
standard Level 1 package. In conventional technology, the high costs and performance limitations of packaging and interconnecting multiple die make application specific implementation of multiple die systems (e.g., MCMs) much more costly than single die ASICs. The invention, however, eliminates many of the costs and performance limitations of multi-die interconnections, thereby enabling economically advantageous implementation of application specific multi-die systems, ASSMs, or ASMs. -
FIG. 20B depicts an exemplaryASM comprising ASSMs solder bump 188 and capacitively signalling throughdielectric 189. Use of the assembly/testing techniques of the present invention permits very low cost and high yield, high reliability fabrication ofASM 190. -
FIG. 20A depictsASSMs ASSM 186 is depicted;ASSM 186 may advantageously mate with more than one other ASSM 186 a. Either or both ofASSMs - Structurally,
ASSMs electronic devices Conductive contact pads solder ball 188 or the like, so as to provide a means for powering ASSM 186 a fromASSM 186. Capacitive signalling betweendevices wiring 185 b, driver/receiver 183 b, coupled half-capacitors receiver 183 a andwiring 185 a.ASSM 186 optionally includesadditional wiring 185 c, driver/receiver(s) 183 c and half-capacitor(s) 182 c to accommodate additional ASSM(s). Use of the ASM design paradigm in accordance with the present invention effectively extends the reach of application specific implementation technology to systems too large to implement with acceptable yield on a single die. - Reference is now made to
FIG. 21 , which depicts a cable interface utilizing the capacitive interface of the invention.Cable 410 comprises anouter sheath 418 encapsulating a plurality oftransmission lines 413 disposed in an appropriately selected dielectricinner medium 419.Transmission lines 413 each preferably connect to half-capacitors 414 atinterface 412 so as to form a standard interface adapted to mate with another capacitively terminated cable or socket.Interface 414 preferably includes means 415 for affixing 410 to another cable or connector socket, which may entail mechanical guides, optical positioning, registration marks, or other means for positioning and holding thecable 410 to another device's interface.Interface 414 may be flat or patterned to enhance alignment stability.Cable 410 may additionally incorporate one or more lines adapted for conductive interconnection atinterface 414. - Use of half-capacitor cable interfaces in accordance with the invention provides numerous advantages over conventional cable connections. Coupled half-capacitors allow substantially better impedance matching at the interface than conventional conductive interfaces. In addition, the invention permits substantially denser interconnections at the interface. Also, capacitive cable interfaces are simpler to fabricate and offer higher reliability (in terms of resistance to contamination corrosion) than conventional conductive cable connections.
- Reference is now made to
FIG. 22 , which depicts an exemplary portion of a modular electronic system wherein a substrate provides both inter-chip and intra-chip capacitive signal paths. - Inter-chip
capacitive signal path 402interconnects chips capacitive signal path 403 b interconnects two points onchip 400 a via a transmission line and two half-capacitors onsubstrate 404. Intra-chipcapacitive signal path 403 a similarly interconnects two points onchip 400 b. It should be noted that signal paths need not be simply inter-chip or intra-chip. For example, the pattern of transmission lines onsubstrate 404 may include branches which implement a hybrid signal path, providing both inter-chip and intra-chip interconnections. -
Chips conductive power connections substrate 404. Alternatively, a powering means such as 401 b might provide connectivity to a battery supply comprised by thechip 400 b, thesubstrate 404, or elsewhere in the system, preferably eliminating the need for external power connections. Numerous means for powering electronic devices are well-known in the art and may be employed advantageously alongside the invention. - Reference is now made to
FIG. 23A , which depicts an exemplary apparatus for testing modules constructed in accordance with the invention. A module-under-test 296 couples capacitively to a test-module 297, which drives test vectors and receives (and optionally evaluates) test signals. Importantly, from the perspective of module-under-test 296, the electrical interface to test-module 297 can be made essentially identical to the interface that module-under-test 296 will see when installed in an actual system. Therefore, module-under-test 296 can be tested at full speed without any need to over-design the drivers on it to accommodate the higher parasitics of a testing fixture. The apparatus permits circuits being tested inmodule 296 to be operated at full speed with essentially no parasitics. Except for latency, the test signals can be made substantially the same as those seen when coupled to a second “real” module, and the latency can be made arbitrarily small. - Conventional test procedures involve actual contact between each contact point on a die and a corresponding probe on a test fixture. This typically requires specialized microscopes or similar optical alignment means, and a fragile, expensive “bed-of-nails” or sacrificial test rig. In contrast, the invention preferably utilizes capacitive alignment in which a tuned circuit on the module-under-
test 296 or ontest module 297 is used to servo a capacitance extremization (and thus alignment) between certain half-capacitors on module-under-test 296 and test-module 297. Such capacitive alignment advantageously obviates any need for expensive optical alignment equipment. Of course, other circuitry can instead be used to facilitate the alignment process, although tuned circuitry is advantageous and capacitive means may be preferable since already available. - During testing, module-under-
test 296 is positioned relative to test-module 297 and mated such that signals can pass between a plurality of respective coupled half-capacitors conductive connections module 297 to provide power to module-under-test 296 during the testing cycle, and possibly during a fine alignment cycle. - The test assembly 296-297 is durable and may advantageously be constructed by a process of building or
unbuilding modules signal junctions 296 a-297 a. It preferably does not require sacrificial test-rigs, nor the severing or joining of conductor-conductor signal junctions. - Referring again to
FIG. 23A , either or both module-under-test 296 and test-module 297 preferably comprise undiced wafers. Advantageously, test-module 297 includes a plurality of testing circuits, each associated with one or more particular half-capacitors 297 a and adapted to generate and/or evaluate test signals at the particular half-capacitor(s). Such testing circuits implemented on the active surface of test-module 297 (preferably near or beneath half-capacitors 297 a) substantially increase the bandwidth of the testing process. In order to compensate for the presence of defective testing circuits, one may sequentially test a given module-under-test 296 using two or more different test-modules 297, thereby ensuring that each circuit (or die) on the module-under-test is tested by at least one operational test circuit on at least one of the test-modules. - A wafer-scale test-
module 297 may also be advantageously used as a micrometer caliper when many components are assembled into a multichip module, thereby effectively providing long-distance fiducials. - Module-under-
test 296 need not be passivated. Indeed, a high dielectric factor material may advantageously be disposed on the plurality of half-capacitors 297 a, and not on half-capacitors 296 a, to lower manufacturing costs and simplify testing. Use of a lower-than-designed dielectric factor or greater separation can advantageously help identify weak drivers or receivers. Likewise, a higher-than-designed dielectric factor or smaller separation can advantageously simulate over-strong communications circuitry. Varying separation and/or alignment between module-under-test 296 and test-module 297 during parametric testing may be used to simulate various environmental extremes. As a result, full parametric testing can be done easily, exercising permutations of extreme variance in clock rate, temperature, voltage, and so forth. - Numerous means for powering module-under-
test 296 are known in the art. Preferably, module-under-test 296 is powered through a conductive connection between respective contact points 296 b and 297 b formed from reversible fuzz buttons, compliant conductive material, or AMPSTAR™—like springy contacts. - Although the testing protocols discussed in regard to
FIGS. 23A, 25 and 26 are exemplified with reference to the testing of an undiced semiconductor wafer, these testing protocols are applicable to modules at any level in the packaging hierarchy, to the extent that such higher-level modules employ the capacitive interfaces associated with the invention. - Testing of modules constructed in accordance with the invention affords significant advantages, compared to testing of conventional, conductively interconnected modules. One advantage is the substantially reduced cost of the test fixture (e.g., test-module 297). The cost of conventional testing depends largely on the number of conductive connections between fixture and module-under-test. A conventional system requires conductive signal connections for each node being stimulated and each node being observed, as well as conductive connections for powers and grounds. The present invention eliminates the need for all these conductive connections, except for powers and grounds (e.g., 296 b and 297 b). Advantageously, power and ground may be applied to module-under-
test 296 via a network on theback side 296 c, thereby completely eliminating the need for conductive connections between module-under-test 296 and test-module 297. In either case, the cost of a non-conductively coupled test-module 297 will generally be substantially less than the cost of a comparable conductively coupled fixture. - In cases requiring a very high density of interconnections between fixture and module-under-test, use of the
non-conductive interconnections 296 a-297 a of the invention permits a substantially greater number of signal connections between module-under-test 296 and test-module 297 to be realized. Therefore, the present invention provides substantially increased controllability and observability of module-under-test 296. This capability to provide very high interconnection density between module-under-test 296 and test-fixture 297 is particularly valuable in the testing of very small modules (e.g., silicon dies) and makes economically feasible the manufacture of larger and/or denser circuitry on such modules because of the increased capability and reduced cost of the testing process. - It is well known that identification of known-good die is critical to the economics of high-yield assembly of MCMs. (See Hagge et al., “High-Yield Assembly of Multichip Modules Through Known-Good IC's and Effective Test Strategies.” Proc. of the IEEE, December 1992, and “Known Good Die.”, 1993 Proceedings, International Conference on Multichip Modules, International Society for Hybrid Microelectronics, Reston Va. 1993.) Deficiencies in the ability of present testing techniques to identify defective die prior to assembly into an MCM contribute approximately ten to fifty percent of the cost of present day MCMs. (See Tai et al., “Exploration and Advances in MCM Technology.” IEEE Multi-Chip Module Conference MCMC-93, Santa Cruz, Calif.) The invention provides novel testing methods which dramatically reduce these costs. These methods reduce the problem of identifying Known Good Die[s] (which in the prior art typically entails packaging a die in a sacrificial test rig and tolerating poorly matched or poorly characterized parasitics) into the Known Good Chip problem whose treatment is well-known by practitioners in semiconductor fabrication. Moreover, packaged chips can still be tested after assembly into a module, just by opening the module and removing some of the high resolution signal substrate or other chips overlaying the suspect chip. A specialized test rig can then be applied directly to the chip, either in situ or after removal from the module.
- Still referring to
FIG. 23A , test-module 297 advantageously incorporates test-circuitry (not depicted) operable to apply and/or receive and evaluate test data from module-under-test 296 via half-capacitors 297 a. Such incorporated test-circuitry provides in effect a “built-in self-test” (“BIST”) capability, but without the disadvantages of conventional approaches. With conventional built-in self-test, significant real estate on the module-under-test must be used to implement the testing circuits, which increases the cost, decreases the performance and decreases the yield of the module-under-test. Because the invention allows test circuitry to be implemented on the test-module (as opposed to the module-under-test), it eliminates these problems of conventional built-in self-test, while retaining the advantages of low cost for test equipment and procedures, high observability/controllability, high testing bandwidth, and so forth. Thus, the incorporation of test-circuitry into test-module 297 in accordance with the invention enables a variety of novel approaches for testing, verifying and repairing modular electronic systems. Self-test circuits can still be built in, but do not need to be built in. The test method does not disadvantage or rule out the use of boundary scan methods, examination by electron beams, or the use of plasmas for testing, but it makes them less necessary by comparison. - In the prior art, changes to built-in self-test circuitry require expensive mask changes to the module-under-test. Such mask changes often introduce costly new failure modes and subtle side effects, which eventually may require still further engineering changes and increase the time-to-market. The present invention permits changes to the “built-in” testing hardware (i.e. test-circuitry on test-module 297) usually without requiring any changes to the part being manufactured (i.e. module-under-test 296), thereby substantially reducing the cost and risk associated with changes in the testing process of a production part. Further, different test-
modules 297 may be advantageously employed to qualify a module-under-test 296 for different specifications, such as military, high-speed commercial, or low-cost commercial. - The method and apparatus can test or validate any
module 296, so any module which can be built can be tested. In the prior art, particularly at higher clock rates, it is possible to build a die or submodule which cannot be tested until fully assembled into a system, which may be combinatorily prohibitive. (DEC's 36-bit Jupiter machine proved untestable hence unbuildable for this reason, ending that company's line of 36-bit machines.) In accordance with the invention, testing is advantageously performed before spending money to package the module-under-test, which is often infeasible in the prior art. - Reference is now made to
FIG. 23B , which depicts the use of mated, undiced wafers to implement fault-tolerant, wafer-scale modular electronic systems in accordance with the invention. - Important examples include applications for a breadboard (optionally including a routing network), for wafer-scale integration per se, and in multi-die systems of wafer-scale or smaller.
- Breadboards serve purposes well-known to practitioners in the field, such as providing a readily customized routing network.
- Using the invention, the off-die connectivity of a wafer-
scale module 396 may be defined by customizing the interconnections oninterconnection substrate 397, capacitively coupled to the wafer-scale module. Such personalized interconnections can be made durable enough to be “shipped,” not just handled in a laboratory. Most of the uses and benefits of wire-wrap coupling can be exploited by breadboard-like interconnection substrates 397 using capacitive coupling, but without paying wire-wrap's penalties for size, power, reliability, durability, parts count, or other factors. The interconnections oninterconnection substrate 397 are advantageously made electrically configurable by use of programmable logic devices (PLDs). - Personalizing wafer-scale systems is straightforward using the invention, as outlined above, since the matrix of interconnections on
interconnection substrate 397 can be lithographed or assembled in one piece in a fixed amount of time, rather than wired in a time proportional to the number of leads. Unlike conventional breadboards, such interconnection substrates are mechanically stable and compact enough for commercial production runs. In addition, submodules may readily be swapped in or out by replacing, reconfiguring, or otherwise altering the interconnection network represented on 397. - Unneeded good dies on wafer-
scale module 396 can be powered or unpowered, depending on the maintenance strategy. Extra good functional units, so called “hot spares,” may be advantageously exploited through adaptive configuration or targeted compiler output. For instance, Very Long Instruction Word (VLIW) compiler techniques can be used to generate object code optimized to the custom configuration of circuits found to be good on the wafer-scale module 296. - Referring again to
FIG. 23B , personalization of such a wafer-scale modular system may also be achieved by use of aninterconnection substrate 397 comprising a routing network to programmably interconnect half-capacitors 397 a onmodule 397. Routing networks offer a general means for redefining pairedcouples 297 a-397 a. In testing, routing networks may be advantageously used to reconfigure the configuration ofmodule 297 by rerouting signals from the half-capacitors 297 a associated with defective test circuitry to other functioning test circuitry during a second testing phase; the second phase tests the circuits on module-under-test 296 missed during the first testing phase. - The interconnections on
interconnection substrate 397 can be personalized either through hardware configuration or software programming of an incorporated routing network. On the hardware side, customization of a coarse resolution substrate entails opening or closing connections among leads, using any of a variety of techniques. Cutting connections is the simplest. Customization at the high resolution substrate could be done in a number of ways, including metallizing leads, opening or closing fuses with a laser, or voting. Various xerographic or mundane photoresist processes might be employed to create custom multilayer high resolution interconnect substrates rapidly. - On the software side, there exists a large body of literature analyzing how to use routing networks or buses to arbitrate communication among dies when the exact pattern of faults will not be known until after fabrication. If the individual dies on a wafer have to be large, which is desirable when signalling is expensive, their yield collapses and connecting good die together can become a prohibitively general problem. Worse, the real estate given over to editing out faults with conductive connections can easily swamp the gains in density won by wafer-scale fabrication, as has been demonstrated by the many failed wafer-scale integration efforts in the prior art.
- Buses or routing networks can be made fully general, independent of the detailed fault map, for a bounded fault density. They can also be reconfigured dynamically, allowing hot restart with spare dies. The fault tolerant routing network or bus may be a significant, even dominant, portion of the overall real estate of a wafer such as 296. Fault tolerant interconnection mechanisms become important in systems with a large number of components, at the system level if not at the module level. Implementation details of such schemes are available in published literature. One can avoid global interconnect schemes by developing locally fault tolerant clusters, leaving longer distance interconnects possibly fault intolerant. For example, nine adders might be fabricated into a cluster requiring eight, with entirely local circuitry concealing a bad unit. No external customization of interconnect wiring would then be needed.
- Reference is now made to
FIGS. 24 and 25 , which compare the fabrication of MCMs in the present art (FIG. 24 ) and the fabrication of wafer-scale modules in accordance with the invention (FIG. 25 ). - Referring now to
FIG. 24 , prior art assembly methods typically entail an initial sequence ofsteps steps steps 420 g-h) involves implementing wiring on an MCM substrate onto which the known good die are bonded, by flip-chip, wire-bond or TAB. In either case, the known good die are subjected to substantial high-temperature and/or mechanically stressful processing steps after theinitial step 420 b test that identified the die as good. Therefore, complete functional test of the assembled system (step 420 i) is advisable to ensure a working multi-die system. - Reference is now made to
FIG. 25 , which shows the assembly of a wafer-scale system in accordance with the invention proceeds initially, in steps 421 a-b, along the same course as the conventional manufacturing methods. (The testing instep 421 b, however, advantageously utilizes the methods discussed in reference toFIG. 23 above.) Wafer-scale module 396, however, is not separated into individual die. Rather, instep 421 e,interconnection substrate 397 is personalized, in response to the results ofstep 421 b, so as to realize a pattern of interconnect, half-capacitors and/or power connections that will interconnect and power the known good die to form the desired system. Instep 421 f, the unsawed wafer-scale module 396 is mated with thepersonalized interconnection substrate 397 to realize the wafer-scale modular system. Step 421 i optionally performs a final system test. - Advantageously, the wafer-scale assembly method depicted in
FIG. 25 does not subject the known good die to high-temperature or other physically stressful processing steps. Therefore, the likelihood that a die identified instep 421 b as good will fail at thefinal step 421 i test is dramatically reduced, as compared to the conventional methods ofFIG. 24 . Moreover, even if such failures occur, rework in accordance with the invention is substantially simpler since it advantageously confines changes to theinterconnection substrate 397 and does not require changes to the unsawed wafer-scale module 396 and since the mating to the unsawed wafer-scale module can be easily reversed without damage to either. - Personalization of the interconnection substrate is advantageously performed by selectively deleting power and/or ground contacts, preferably fuzz buttons like
metallic protrusions 397 k, corresponding to known bad dies from a coarse resolution power substrate portion of the interconnection substrate. Bad dies will therefore not be powered, so shorts or other defects in them can be electrically isolated from the system. This process of editing out defects by deleting connections to power and/or ground isolates bad dies as effectively as sawing them out would, for any point defect or region defect of the unsawed wafer; equivalently, power connections could be enabled only for known good die. - Referring again to
FIG. 23B ,interconnection substrate 397 can be fabricated by a number of methods, including those taught earlier. It may be the same size as theunsawed wafer 396 or composed of regularly or irregularly tiled smaller sections. It may also be built of one or more wafers or dies itself. Leads can be brought outside through fuzz buttons at the same cost as in conductively coupled systems, and breadboarded or connected to other components in a traditional fashion. - Leaving
wafer 396 undiced saves manufacturing steps and wastes less real estate. While electrically empty gutters are still needed to separate dies, the neighbor-to-neighbor die separation need only be about 10 microns in the current art, which is realistic in light of present technology for stepping cameras and is comparable to the separation of neighboring half-capacitor plates on a die. This amounts to less than one percent of the real estate for a 2 mm2 die. (N.B.: If the capacitive coupling were designed with much smaller separation (e.g., h=1 micron), the line width would then have to be considered in the optimization, since the gutter must also be wider than several standard deviations of the linewidth.) In comparison, the gutters needed when die are to be sawed are typically 300-900 microns wide, and restricted to having common edges abutting chords across the wafer, typically in a rectangular grid. The embodiment taught above removes the requirement for colinearity, which makes available the real estate padded out to form rectangular dies from non-rectangular layouts, and facilitates the placement of fabrication process control cells, which, in the prior art, are typically lithographed in the gutters. Leaving the wafer unsawed also avoids stress-induced failures from handling, sawing, or drilling, which increases yield. Also, since all of the active die used to form the wafer-scale module advantageously derive from a single wafer, wafer-to-wafer variances in device parameters are not relevant. - Reference is now made to
FIG. 26 , which depicts the general flow of assembly, testing and rework of a wafer-scale or similar modular system in accordance with the present invention. Amodule 431 is initially provided from existing prefabricated stock (e.g., a configurable array or the like) or manufactured by manufacturing means 430.Module 431 is characterized by testing means 433 to produce adescription 434 of its actual performance. In response toperformance description 434, layout generation means utilizes well-known CAD techniques to generate ageometric description 436 of an interconnection substrate. In response togeometric description 436, substrate generation means 437 personalizes aninterconnection substrate 442. - Assembly means 432 then assembles
substrate 442 and thewafer 431 into a (potentially operable)module 443. System testing means 440 compares the behavior ofmodule 443 with a description of the desired system behavior. Ifmodule 443 tests acceptably, system testing means 440 designates the module as a knowngood module 441. If, on the other hand, it identifies problems in the performance ofmodule 443, system testing means 440 generates reworkinstructions 438 for substrate generation means 437, in which case a new or reworked interconnection substrate is created and tested. - Various novel methods for testing and assembling wafer-scale systems have been discussed previously. The invention further provides advantages in terms of repair, optimization and/or rework of such modular systems. Since wiring is advantageously disposed on mated modules, a die or submodule identified as bad can be identified and swapped out with much less tear-down and rebuild than would be required in test-replace cycles for conductively coupled systems in the prior art. Non-destructive assembly and disassembly in accordance with the invention advantageously allows full systems to be built for testing and torn down for repair with substantially no damage to submodules. Reparability is facilitated by the lack of impact on neighboring die, tolerance of alignment mis-registration, absence of metal fatigue, and simplicity of testing, among other factors.
- Rework involves disassembling a modular system and repairing or replacing a module so as to correct a performance deficiency. Importantly, rework may be used not only to repair or replace inoperable modules, but also to repair or replace slow or otherwise suboptimal modules so as to improve the performance of an already operable system.
- In accordance with the invention, the forming or breaking of capacitive signal junctions advantageously entails substantially zero force, sheer, torque, or change in energy across any pair of coupled half-capacitors. Such assembly or disassembly advantageously proceeds with: no rise or fall in temperature at the signal junctions; no application or removal of heat at the signal junctions; no severing or joining of conductor-conductor leads at the signal junctions; no melting, solidifying, or other phase changes at the signal junctions; and/or no use of conductive liquids, solids, pastes, gases, plasmas, solvents, suspensions, or combinations of these at the signal junctions. Those skilled in the art will appreciate the cost and complexity advantages afforded by the avoidance of each of these requirements of various prior art disassembly methods.
- Reference is now made to
FIG. 27 , which shows the yield of good dies in a typical semiconductor fabrications process as a function of die size. For an average of 1 fault per square centimeter, a Poisson distribution of point-localized defects predicts defect-less yields of approximately 90% for 0.10 cm2 die, 37% for 1.0 cm2 die, and 5% for 3 cm2 die, which are realistic figures for certain mature VLSI processes. Under these conditions, a 60 cm2 wafer would on average yield approximately 1good die of 3 cm2 size, or 21 of 1 cm2 size, or 540 of 10 mm2size. A good 10 cm2 die will be found, on average, once every 22 ft2 of wafer, and thus is not a practical design target. - Given the foregoing yield constraints, it is readily apparent that a system much larger than approximately the average fault density (1.0 cm2 in this example) may advantageously be fractionated into subunits (e.g., die) which can themselves be manufactured with significantly better yield.
- At a high level of abstraction, the choice of die size can be viewed as essentially a tradeoff between system cost and system performance. While techniques for analyzing these system partitioning issues are known for conventional, conductively interconnected systems, the analysis of such tradeoffs for the capacitively interconnected systems of the invention requires different yield and performance models. An exemplary yield model for a capacitively interconnected system appears below.
- Reference is now made to
FIG. 28 , which depicts several plots of system cost as a function of die size for an exemplary capacitively interconnected system.FIG. 28 shows the value of fractionating large dies into smaller ones and coupling them together using the invention. The cost for a substrate to interconnect signal lines is assumed to be much, much smaller than the cost of the dies themselves, so can generally be ignored to a first approximation. A system requiring a certain amount of silicon real estate (e.g., 10 cm2 for useful circuitry) might variously be designed as one 10 cm2 piece, ten 1.0 cm2 pieces, one hundred 0.1 cm2 pieces, or so forth. In addition to the 10 cm2 of useful circuitry, additional real estate must be taken up in every case for power and ground, and also taken up on each of the fractionated dies for “overhead” circuitry for inter-die communication that would not otherwise have been necessary in a single die, including drivers, level-to-pulse converters, pulse-to-level converters, and/or receivers. InFIG. 28 , the communication real estate on each die is estimated for illustrative purposes to scale in several ways: intrace 299 a as a constant (i.e. no dependence on the overall number of pieces), intrace 299e as a constant times the number of pieces (i.e. a unit of circuitry for communicating with every other piece), and as a constant times the number of pieces raised to the intermediate powers of ¼, ½, and ¾, intraces - Consider, for example, trace 299 c, in which the communication circuitry is assumed to scale as 0.5 mm2 times the square root of the number of die into which the 10 cm2 of system is packaged.
-
- In a system built from two hundred dies with 5 mm2 of useful circuitry each, each die would need one power-ground pair (0.5 mm2) and 7.1 mm2 (=0.5×2001/2) of communication circuitry, so would actually be a 12.6 mm2 die. The yield for 12.6 mm2 die is 95 percent, so the full system would “cost” about (200×12.6/0.95)=26.5 cm2 of wafer, or 2.6 times as much as the 10.2 cm2 system described above. Very small dies are dominated by the “surface-to-volume” size of their power pads and the circuitry for inter-die communication, so are inefficient even though their yield is high.
- In a system built with fifty dies with 20 mm2 of useful circuitry each, each die would still need one power-ground pair and 3.6 mm2(=0.5×501/2 of communication circuitry, so would actually be a 24.1 mm2 die. The yield for 24.1 mm2 die is 82 percent, so the “cost” of the full system would be about 14.7 cm2 of wafer, or 1.4 times as much as the 10.2 cm2 system described above. For the particular model selected to simulate the cost of power pads, signal circuitry, and useful circuitry, dies of about 20 mm2 provide the most cost effective building blocks.
- In a system built with ten dies with 1.0 cm2 of useful circuitry each, each die would need four power-ground pairs (2.0 mm2) and 1.6 mm2 (=0.5×101/2) of communication circuitry, so would actually be a 103.6 mm2 die. The yield for 103.6 mm2 die is 37 percent, so the “cost” of the full system would be about 28.0 cm2 of wafer, or about 11/4 times as much as the 10.2 cm2 system described above. Large dies lose in fabrication yield more than they gain in design efficiency, and very large dies yield at close to zero, even though they have an even more attractive ratio of useful circuitry to overhead.
- Reference is now made to
FIG. 29 , which depicts the flow of a design cycle in accordance with the present invention. Asystem description 451 is provided to CAD means 450, which advantageously utilizes performance, yield, reliability and cost models for available or manufacturable submodules to produce an optimized design for the modular system, which design is provided to stock or manufacturing means 452 as a list of parts 461, to means for packaging and assembling 456 as a definition ofgeometry 454, and to testing means 459 as a definition of the expected behavior of thesystem 453. -
Parts 455 are provided to means for packaging and assembling 456 from stock or means for manufacturing 452. Themodule 458 is assembled and provided to testing means 459, which decides whether to designate the module as a knowngood module 460 or initiate a rework orcontinuation cycle 457. - CAD means 450 advantageously optimizes the partitioning of the modular system into modules. The present invention permits considerable flexibility in selecting the size of system partitions (e.g., die sizes) since it largely obviates the need to rely on standard pad fan-out and wire-bonding configurations. Therefore, yield modelling, as exemplified in
FIG. 28 above, is advantageously incorporated into CAD means 450 and forms an integral part of the design process for semi-custom systems based on the present invention. - Since the invention facilitates low-cost integration of heterogeneous systems comprising a plurality of modules (each potentially implemented by a different manufacturing technology), such yield models are advantageously derived by curve-fitting data from all available fabrication processes, in order to provide a library of yield models that CAD means 450 can use in optimizing the implementation of a capacitively interconnected system. In addition to such yield models, CAD means 450 advantageously utilizes models of the electrical performance characteristics and other physical characteristics of the various technologies available to implement the modules of a capacitively interconnected system. Equipped with models of the cost, yield, performance and physical characteristics of various technology resources, the CAD means 450 employs well-known algorithms to optimize the partitioning and implementation of a semi-custom, capacitively interconnected system. Such optimization preferably includes: (1) the selection of the sizes and types of modules utilized to construct the system, (2) the assignment of logical subcomponents of the system to particular modules for implementation, and/or (3) the design of patterned substrates or like means for capacitively interconnecting the modules to realize the system.
- Reference is now made to
FIG. 30 , which depicts a block diagram of an off-die capacitive signal path in accordance with the invention. In the signal path shown inFIG. 30 ,digital data 302 is: (1) input totransmitter 300; (2) coupled to die half-capacitor 15 a via transmission line orwire 32 a; (3) coupled from substrate half-capacitor 14 a to substrate half-capacitor 14 b via transmission line orwire 34; (4) coupled from die half-capacitor 15 b toreceiver 301 via transmission line orwire 32 b; and (5) provided asdigital output 304 fromreceiver 301. -
Transmitter 300 andreceiver 301 may be implemented on the same die 10 (an intra-die off-die signal path) or on different dies (an inter-die signal path).Transmitter 300 andreceiver 301 are preferably implemented on the active surface ofdie 10, preferably directly beneath half-capacitors -
Transmitter 300 transformsdigital input data 302 to a form appropriate for transmission on the capacitive signal path. Such transformations might include, for example, level shifting, edge rate modification, phase, frequency or amplitude modulation of an appropriate carrier, coding of data using Non Return to Zero (NRZ) or Alternate Mark Inverse (AMI) techniques and the like. -
Receiver 301 preferably performs an inverse transformation on the signal received from die half-capacitor 15 b to generatedigital output signal 304. Preferably,receiver 301 converts modulated signals coupled from substrate half-capacitor 14 b into digital data by detection, discrimination or pulse slicing techniques, or by recovery of AMI or NRZ data. In the preferred embodiments, the waveform coupled to the receiver online 32 b is either a pulse or a level waveform. -
FIG. 30 depicts a single-ended capacitive signal path for illustrative purposes. It should be noted, however, that differential signalling, as depicted in later figures, is considered preferable. It should also be noted that a receiver or driver could be connected to more than one half-capacitor, and that both a receiver and a driver could be connected to a single half-capacitor or collection of capacitive coupling means. It should be further noted thattransmission line 34 is merely exemplary. Receivers and/or transmitters could be implemented directly onsubstrate 11, preferably beneath or near half-capacitors 14 a and/or 14 b. - Reference is now made to
FIGS. 31A and 31B , which depict a final stage of the preferred embodiment oftransmitter 300. InFIG. 31A , a transmitter includes a means 300 a for rapidly switching theoutput signal 32 a between twovoltage levels switches control signals digital data 302 entering the transmitter. -
FIG. 31B depicts a preferred embodiment of the means for rapidly switching comprising aCMOS inverter 300 b.Inverter 300 b requires only asingle control signal 314, which controls bothPMOS switch 315 andNMOS switch 316. - The switching means 300 a of
transmitter 300 imparts a waveform on substrate half-capacitor 14 a (and transmission line 34) whenoutput 32 a switches voltage levels. Iftransmission line 34 is terminated, the imparted waveform will be a pulse. If wiring is unterminated, the waveform will be a level voltage. - Reference is now made to
FIG. 32 , which depicts a preferred embodiment of a switching means adapted to drive a differential capacitive signal path. Differential switching means 300 c comprises acontrol signal inverter 321 and four switches 322-325. Depending on the state ofcontrol signal 314, one ofvoltage levels output line 32 a while the other voltage level is coupled tooutput line 32 aa. Die half-capacitors - Reference is now made to
FIG. 33 , which depicts a simplified electrical model of the interface between an exemplary switching means 300 and a terminatedsubstrate transmission line 330. Alevel waveform 333 is applied to switching means 300 a, which couples a similar waveform to die half-capacitor 15 a. In response thereto, apulse waveform 334 is imparted onsubstrate transmission line 330. Atermination resistor 331 connected betweentransmission line 330 and anAC ground 332 terminatestransmission line 330. - Reference is now made to
FIG. 34 , which depicts a simplified electrical model of the interface between an exemplary switching means 300 and unterminatedsubstrate wiring line 330 b. Alevel waveform 333 is applied to switching means 300, which couples a similar waveform to die half-capacitor 15 a. In response thereto, alevel waveform 335 is imparted onsubstrate wiring 330 b.Capacitor 336 represents the parasitic capacitance betweenunterminated wiring 330 b andAC ground 332. A voltage divider is formed bycapacitor 336 and the coupled half-capacitors waveform 335 represents a reduced swing version ofwaveform 333. - Reference is now made to
FIG. 35 , which depicts a block diagram of a preferred, differential off-die signal path in accordance with the invention. In the path shown inFIG. 35 ,digital data 302 is: (1) input totransmitter 300 a; (2) coupled differentially to die half-capacitors capacitors capacitors receiver 301 a viatransmission lines digital output 304 fromreceiver 301 a. -
Differential transmitter 300 a andreceiver 301 a may be implemented on the same die 10 (an intra-die off-die signal path) or different dies (an inter-die signal path).Transmitter 300 a andreceiver 301 a are preferably implemented on the active surface ofdie 10, preferably directly beneath half-capacitors 15 a-15 aa and 15 b-15 bb, respectively. Advantageously, one side of the differential signal path can be employed as a “reference line,” for example, by enlarging half-capacitors 14 aa, 15 aa, 14 bb, and 15 bb. - As with the single-ended capacitive signal paths, pulse or level waveforms on
transmission lines transmitter 300 a andreceiver 301 a. However, other differential signalling techniques, such as those based on modulation of amplitude, phase, frequency or signal-to-noise ratio, may also be used to transmit data via the differential capacitive signal paths of the invention. Certain combinations of pulse and level waveforms offer advantageous implementations, such as a configuration wherein a transmitter drives a single-ended pulse and the receiver reads a differential signal, taking a level waveform, preferentially ground, as the other side of the difference. - Reference is now made to
FIG. 36 , which is a schematic diagram of an exemplary single-endedreceiver 301 compatible for use in the signal path depicted inFIG. 30 .Receiver 301 converts a pulse waveform received on half-capacitor 15 b and coupled viawiring 32 b to adigital output 304.Receiver 301 comprises a biasing means 360 coupled to inputline 32 b, a slicing means 361 also coupled to inputline 32 b, and a pulse-to-level converter 362 coupled to the slicing means. - Biasing means 360 comprises a resistive means 363 coupled to input
line 32 b and a voltage generator means 364 coupled to the resistive means. Resistive means 363 preferably comprises anMOS transistor 365. Voltage generator means 364 preferably comprises a feedback-connected CMOS inverter wherein the relative sizes ofPMOS transistor 366 andNMOS transistor 367 are selected to provide the desired bias voltage. Preferably, this ratio of transistor sizes is the same as that for an ordinary inverter in the given process, so as to provide a bias voltage approximately equal to the switching threshold of an ordinary inverter. Resistive means 363 and voltage generator means 364 are designed to track process variations. Advantageously, a single voltage generator means 364 may be used in conjunction with multipleresistive means 363 to bias multiple half-capacitor plates 15 b. - Slicing means 361 illustratively comprises a high-
threshold inverter 368 and a low-threshold inverter 369, both coupled to inputline 32 b. High-threshold inverter 368 preferably comprises a CMOS inverter having a PMOS-to-NMOS size ratio larger than that ofvoltage generator 364. Similarly, low-threshold inverter 369 preferably comprises a CMOS inverter having a PMOS-to-NMOS size ratio smaller than that ofvoltage generator 364. Slicing means detects deviations of the voltage oninput line 32 b imparted by signals coupled from half-capacitor 15 b, as either pulse or level waveforms. The switching thresholds ofinverters - Pulse-to-
level converter 362 comprises an R-S flip-flop, includinginverter 372 and cross-coupled NAND gates 373-374, all preferably implemented in CMOS. Pulse-to-level converter 362 effectively reconstructs the digital waveform driven bytransmitter 300 on half-capacitor 15 a (SeeFIG. 30 ).Output 370 from slicing means 361 drives the Set input of pulse-to-level converter 362, thereby drivingdigital output 304 low when a positive pulse or level change is imparted oninput line 32 b. Similarly,output 371 from slicing means 361 drives the Reset input of pulse-to-level converter 362, thereby drivingdigital output 304 high when a negative pulse or level change is imparted oninput line 32 b. Pulse-to-level converter 362 is preferably designed such that the timings in the Set and Reset paths of the R-S flip-flop are substantially identical, so as to provide adigital output waveform 304 having substantially the same timing as thedigital input waveform 302 attransmitter 300. - Reference is now made to
FIG. 37 , which is a schematic diagram of an exemplarydifferential receiver 301 a compatible for use in the signal path depicted inFIG. 35 . Differential receiver comprises a biasing means 380, a signal conditioning means 384, a slicing means 361 and a pulse-to-level converter 362.Receiver 301 a receives a differential pulse or level waveform input from half-capacitors 15 b-15 bb and provides adigital output 304. - Biasing means 380 comprises a voltage generator means 383, first resistive means 381 and second resistive means 382. Voltage generator means 383 preferably comprises an ordinary sized, feedback-connected CMOS inverter. First resistive means 381 comprises an appropriately sized NMOS transistor connected between voltage generator means 383 and
input line 32 bb. Second resistive means similarly comprises an appropriately sized NMOS transistor connected between voltage generator means 383 andinput line 32 b. Biasing means 380 advantageously tracks process variations. - Signal conditioning means 384 receives differential input from
lines 32 b versus 32 bb and provides a single-endedoutput 390, thereby enhancing the rejection of common-mode noise or other signals oninput lines current source 385 and the gates ofload devices lines differential pair output voltage 390 with the input threshold of a nominal CMOS inverter across process, temperature and supply voltage variations, as well as good common mode and power supply rejection. Thus, signal conditioning means 384 provides anoutput 390 approximately equal to the switching threshold of an ordinary CMOS inverter when itsinputs - The single-ended output from signal conditioning means 384 is provided to slicing means 361, which drives the Set and Reset inputs 370-371 of pulse-to-
level converter 362 to providedigital output 304. Slicing means 361 and pulse-to-level converter 362 have been previously described in regard toFIG. 26 . - Reference is now made to FIGS. 38A-B.
FIG. 38A shows an exploded view of a modular system including atransmission line 471 onmodule 470 and aparallel transmission line 474 onmodule 473. Coupledtransmission lines modules FIG. 38B shows an exploded view of an alternative arrangement, whereintransmission line 471 onmodule 470 andperpendicular transmission line 477 on module 476 couple magnetically, thereby providing a means for non-conductively signalling betweenmodules 470 and 476. Signalling means 472 comprises a transmitter and signalling means 475 comprises a receiver, and/or vice versa. - While the invention has been illustrated with reference to preferred embodiments utilizing capacitive coupling, other modes of non-conductive interconnection, as described in
FIG. 38 , can be used to construct modular systems in accordance with the invention. U.S. Pat. No. 5,012,321, entitled INTERCONNECTION DEVICE BETWEEN THE CELLS OF A PRE-IMPLANTED HYPERFREQUENCY INTEGRATED CIRCUIT, incorporated herein by reference, teaches the use of transmission line coupling between overlapping microstrips as a technique for implementing a custom interconnect layer on a pre-implanted hyperfrequency integrated circuit. The '321 patent differs from the present invention in at least two important respects: (1) the '321 patent does not teach the use of transmission line coupling to signal inter-chip between different modules in a modular system, or intra-chip via an off-chip path such as between two units of a chip via a distinct capacitively coupled substrate; and (2) the '321 patent expressly excludes “integrated circuits on silicon . . . operating at a low frequency.” - We have found that with a sufficiently high dielectric factor, transmission line coupling as depicted in
FIG. 38 may be used in place of previously described half-capacitor coupling methods to implement a means for non-conductively signalling in accordance with the present invention, and that such alternative signalling means may thus be used in silicon-based systems such as CMOS. In particular, modular microwave and millimeter wave systems can advantageously employ transmission line coupling as a means for non-conductively signalling between modules in the system. Additionally, it may be advantageous to distribute clock signals and the like through coupled transmission lines. In these and similar circumstances, transmission line coupling and capacitive coupling represent alternative means for non-conductively signalling. Thus, the present invention encompasses modular electronic systems in which at least some of the modules communicate via coupled half-capacitors, coupled transmission lines, or both.
Claims (17)
1. A modular electronic system comprising:
a substrate including a transmission line and a ground plane for the transmission line;
a monolithic integrated circuit chip including digital circuitry;
means for powering said chip; and, means mounted in part on the substrate and in part on the chip for capacitively coupling digital signals between said chip and said substrate.
2-26. (Cancelled).
27. A modular electronic system as defined in claim 1 wherein said transmission line comprises a stripline, a microchip or a slotline.
28-29. (Cancelled).
30. A modular electronic system as defined in claim 1 wherein said transmission line is coupled to said means for capacitively coupling.
31. A modular electronic system as defined in claim 30 wherein said transmission line is further coupled to a second means for capacitively coupling.
32-205. (Cancelled).
206. A modular electronic system as defined in claim 20 wherein said transmission line is terminated.
207. A modular electronic system as defined in claim 20 wherein said transmission line connects a plurality of points together electrically.
208. A modular electronic system as defined in claim 20, wherein said plurality of points includes a plurality of listeners.
209. A modular electronic system as defined in claim 20, wherein said plurality of points includes a plurality of senders.
210. A modular electronic system as defined in claim 20, wherein said plurality of points includes a plurality of transmission lines.
211. A modular electronic system comprising a first module, including a first array; and
a second module, including a second array; and
a third module, including a third array and a fourth array, said third array capacitively coupled to said first array, and said fourth array capacitively coupled to said second array;
each array comprising a plurality of half-capacitors.
212. A modular electronic system as defined in claim 211 further comprising a fourth module, including a fifth array; and
said second module further including a sixth array;
said fifth array capacitively coupled to said sixth array.
213. A modular electronic system as defined in claim 211 wherein said modules are tiled in a regular geometric pattern.
214. A modular electronic system as defined in claim 211 wherein said modules include a monolithic integrated circuit.
215. A modular electronic system as defined in claim 211 further including structures for facilitating mechanical alignment.
Priority Applications (2)
Application Number | Priority Date | Filing Date | Title |
---|---|---|---|
US10/834,352 US20050002448A1 (en) | 1993-06-24 | 2004-04-27 | Method and apparatus for non-conductively interconnecting integrated circuits |
US12/015,720 US7869221B2 (en) | 1993-06-24 | 2008-01-17 | Apparatus for non-conductively interconnecting integrated circuits |
Applications Claiming Priority (2)
Application Number | Priority Date | Filing Date | Title |
---|---|---|---|
US08/082,328 US6728113B1 (en) | 1993-06-24 | 1993-06-24 | Method and apparatus for non-conductively interconnecting integrated circuits |
US10/834,352 US20050002448A1 (en) | 1993-06-24 | 2004-04-27 | Method and apparatus for non-conductively interconnecting integrated circuits |
Related Parent Applications (1)
Application Number | Title | Priority Date | Filing Date |
---|---|---|---|
US08/082,328 Continuation US6728113B1 (en) | 1993-06-24 | 1993-06-24 | Method and apparatus for non-conductively interconnecting integrated circuits |
Related Child Applications (1)
Application Number | Title | Priority Date | Filing Date |
---|---|---|---|
US12/015,720 Continuation US7869221B2 (en) | 1993-06-24 | 2008-01-17 | Apparatus for non-conductively interconnecting integrated circuits |
Publications (1)
Publication Number | Publication Date |
---|---|
US20050002448A1 true US20050002448A1 (en) | 2005-01-06 |
Family
ID=22170516
Family Applications (5)
Application Number | Title | Priority Date | Filing Date |
---|---|---|---|
US08/082,328 Expired - Lifetime US6728113B1 (en) | 1993-06-24 | 1993-06-24 | Method and apparatus for non-conductively interconnecting integrated circuits |
US08/265,607 Expired - Lifetime US5629838A (en) | 1993-06-24 | 1994-06-24 | Apparatus for non-conductively interconnecting integrated circuits using half capacitors |
US09/459,108 Expired - Fee Related US6916719B1 (en) | 1993-06-24 | 1999-12-10 | Method and apparatus for non-conductively interconnecting integrated circuits |
US10/834,352 Abandoned US20050002448A1 (en) | 1993-06-24 | 2004-04-27 | Method and apparatus for non-conductively interconnecting integrated circuits |
US12/015,720 Expired - Fee Related US7869221B2 (en) | 1993-06-24 | 2008-01-17 | Apparatus for non-conductively interconnecting integrated circuits |
Family Applications Before (3)
Application Number | Title | Priority Date | Filing Date |
---|---|---|---|
US08/082,328 Expired - Lifetime US6728113B1 (en) | 1993-06-24 | 1993-06-24 | Method and apparatus for non-conductively interconnecting integrated circuits |
US08/265,607 Expired - Lifetime US5629838A (en) | 1993-06-24 | 1994-06-24 | Apparatus for non-conductively interconnecting integrated circuits using half capacitors |
US09/459,108 Expired - Fee Related US6916719B1 (en) | 1993-06-24 | 1999-12-10 | Method and apparatus for non-conductively interconnecting integrated circuits |
Family Applications After (1)
Application Number | Title | Priority Date | Filing Date |
---|---|---|---|
US12/015,720 Expired - Fee Related US7869221B2 (en) | 1993-06-24 | 2008-01-17 | Apparatus for non-conductively interconnecting integrated circuits |
Country Status (4)
Country | Link |
---|---|
US (5) | US6728113B1 (en) |
EP (1) | EP0705529A4 (en) |
JP (2) | JP4017186B2 (en) |
WO (1) | WO1995001087A1 (en) |
Cited By (18)
Publication number | Priority date | Publication date | Assignee | Title |
---|---|---|---|---|
US20050077546A1 (en) * | 2003-10-13 | 2005-04-14 | Philip Neaves | Structure and method for forming a capacitively coupled chip-to-chip signaling interface |
US20080128916A1 (en) * | 2006-12-04 | 2008-06-05 | Nec Electronics Corporation | Semiconductor device including microstrip line and coplanar line |
US20080284003A1 (en) * | 2007-05-17 | 2008-11-20 | Chua Swee Kwang | Semiconductor Packages And Method For Fabricating Semiconductor Packages With Discrete Components |
US20090218407A1 (en) * | 2008-02-29 | 2009-09-03 | Broadcom Corporation | Integrated circuit with millimeter wave and inductive coupling and methods for use therewith |
US20100306726A1 (en) * | 2009-06-01 | 2010-12-02 | Ludwig Lester F | Chain/leapfrog circuit topologies and tools for carbon nanotube / graphene nanoribbon nanoelectronics, printed electronics, polymer electronics, and their confluences |
US20110215472A1 (en) * | 2008-06-30 | 2011-09-08 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Through Silicon via Bridge Interconnect |
US8522184B2 (en) | 2010-05-26 | 2013-08-27 | Pike Group Llc | Hierachically-modular nanoelectronic differential amplifiers, op amps, and associated current sources utilizing carbon nanotubes, graphene nanoribbons, printed electronics, polymer semiconductors, or other related materials |
US20130342287A1 (en) * | 2012-06-25 | 2013-12-26 | Dielectric Laboratories, Inc. | High frequency band pass filter with coupled surface mount transition |
US9431337B2 (en) | 2015-01-13 | 2016-08-30 | Noda Screen Co., Ltd. | Semiconductor device having an inner power supply plate structure |
US9741918B2 (en) | 2013-10-07 | 2017-08-22 | Hypres, Inc. | Method for increasing the integration level of superconducting electronics circuits, and a resulting circuit |
US10026771B1 (en) * | 2014-09-30 | 2018-07-17 | Apple Inc. | Image sensor with a cross-wafer capacitor |
US10205898B2 (en) | 2014-10-14 | 2019-02-12 | Apple Inc. | Minimizing a data pedestal level in an image sensor |
US10491748B1 (en) | 2006-04-03 | 2019-11-26 | Wai Wu | Intelligent communication routing system and method |
US11073712B2 (en) | 2018-04-10 | 2021-07-27 | Apple Inc. | Electronic device display for through-display imaging |
US11619857B2 (en) | 2021-05-25 | 2023-04-04 | Apple Inc. | Electrically-tunable optical filter |
US20230236230A1 (en) * | 2022-01-24 | 2023-07-27 | Fujikura Ltd. | Evaluation device of radio communication module |
US12069798B1 (en) * | 2021-04-27 | 2024-08-20 | Lockheed Martin Corporation | Broadside coupled radio frequency interconnect |
US12114089B2 (en) | 2022-08-19 | 2024-10-08 | Apple Inc. | Pixel output parasitic capacitance reduction and predictive settling assist |
Families Citing this family (255)
Publication number | Priority date | Publication date | Assignee | Title |
---|---|---|---|---|
US6728113B1 (en) * | 1993-06-24 | 2004-04-27 | Polychip, Inc. | Method and apparatus for non-conductively interconnecting integrated circuits |
US5777383A (en) * | 1996-05-09 | 1998-07-07 | Lsi Logic Corporation | Semiconductor chip package with interconnect layers and routing and testing methods |
US6329715B1 (en) * | 1996-09-20 | 2001-12-11 | Tdk Corporation | Passive electronic parts, IC parts, and wafer |
DE19722355A1 (en) * | 1997-05-28 | 1998-12-03 | Bosch Gmbh Robert | Method of manufacturing electrical assemblies and electrical assembly |
US5990564A (en) * | 1997-05-30 | 1999-11-23 | Lucent Technologies Inc. | Flip chip packaging of memory chips |
US5793668A (en) * | 1997-06-06 | 1998-08-11 | Timeplex, Inc. | Method and apparatus for using parasitic capacitances of a printed circuit board as a temporary data storage medium working with a remote device |
US20020157082A1 (en) * | 1997-09-30 | 2002-10-24 | Jeng-Jye Shau | Inter-dice wafer level signal transfer methods for integrated circuits |
US20060081971A1 (en) * | 1997-09-30 | 2006-04-20 | Jeng Jye Shau | Signal transfer methods for integrated circuits |
US7898275B1 (en) * | 1997-10-03 | 2011-03-01 | Texas Instruments Incorporated | Known good die using existing process infrastructure |
US6052498A (en) * | 1997-12-19 | 2000-04-18 | Intel Corporation | Method and apparatus providing an optical input/output bus through the back side of an integrated circuit die |
US6330376B1 (en) | 1997-12-19 | 2001-12-11 | Intel Corporation | Higher order rejection method and apparatus for optical modulator |
US6374003B1 (en) | 1997-12-19 | 2002-04-16 | Intel Corporation | Method and apparatus for optically modulating light through the back side of an integrated circuit die using a plurality of optical beams |
US6075908A (en) * | 1997-12-19 | 2000-06-13 | Intel Corporation | Method and apparatus for optically modulating light through the back side of an integrated circuit die |
US6393169B1 (en) | 1997-12-19 | 2002-05-21 | Intel Corporation | Method and apparatus for providing optical interconnection |
US6049639A (en) * | 1997-12-19 | 2000-04-11 | Intel Corporation | Method and apparatus providing optical input/output through the back side of an integrated circuit die |
WO1999033108A1 (en) * | 1997-12-22 | 1999-07-01 | Conexant Systems, Inc. | Wireless inter-chip communication system and method |
US6077309A (en) * | 1998-01-07 | 2000-06-20 | Mentor Graphics Corporation | Method and apparatus for locating coordinated starting points for routing a differential pair of traces |
US6396712B1 (en) * | 1998-02-12 | 2002-05-28 | Rose Research, L.L.C. | Method and apparatus for coupling circuit components |
US6329712B1 (en) | 1998-03-25 | 2001-12-11 | Micron Technology, Inc. | High density flip chip memory arrays |
JP3196719B2 (en) | 1998-03-31 | 2001-08-06 | 日本電気株式会社 | Semiconductor manufacturing line having contamination prevention isolation line, wafer transfer mechanism, and semiconductor manufacturing method |
US6245583B1 (en) * | 1998-05-06 | 2001-06-12 | Texas Instruments Incorporated | Low stress method and apparatus of underfilling flip-chip electronic devices |
US6389566B1 (en) * | 1998-06-02 | 2002-05-14 | S3 Incorporated | Edge-triggered scan flip-flop and one-pass scan synthesis methodology |
US6175124B1 (en) | 1998-06-30 | 2001-01-16 | Lsi Logic Corporation | Method and apparatus for a wafer level system |
US6326677B1 (en) * | 1998-09-04 | 2001-12-04 | Cts Corporation | Ball grid array resistor network |
US6587605B2 (en) | 1999-01-06 | 2003-07-01 | Intel Corporation | Method and apparatus for providing optical interconnection |
US6542720B1 (en) * | 1999-03-01 | 2003-04-01 | Micron Technology, Inc. | Microelectronic devices, methods of operating microelectronic devices, and methods of providing microelectronic devices |
US6144225A (en) | 1999-03-03 | 2000-11-07 | Xilinx, Inc. | Programmable integrated circuit having metal plate capacitors that provide local switching energy |
SE516152C2 (en) * | 1999-03-17 | 2001-11-26 | Ericsson Telefon Ab L M | Apparatus for allowing trimming on a substrate and method for making a substrate for trimming |
US6204815B1 (en) | 1999-04-30 | 2001-03-20 | Xilinx, Inc. | Increased propagation speed across integrated circuits |
US6697420B1 (en) | 1999-05-25 | 2004-02-24 | Intel Corporation | Symbol-based signaling for an electromagnetically-coupled bus system |
US6576847B2 (en) | 1999-05-25 | 2003-06-10 | Intel Corporation | Clamp to secure carrier to device for electromagnetic coupler |
US6449308B1 (en) | 1999-05-25 | 2002-09-10 | Intel Corporation | High-speed digital distribution system |
US6625682B1 (en) * | 1999-05-25 | 2003-09-23 | Intel Corporation | Electromagnetically-coupled bus system |
US6498305B1 (en) | 1999-05-25 | 2002-12-24 | Intel Corporation | Interconnect mechanics for electromagnetic coupler |
US6240622B1 (en) * | 1999-07-09 | 2001-06-05 | Micron Technology, Inc. | Integrated circuit inductors |
US6248604B1 (en) * | 1999-09-14 | 2001-06-19 | Lucent Technologies, Inc. | Method for design and development of a semiconductor laser device |
US6496889B1 (en) * | 1999-09-17 | 2002-12-17 | Rambus Inc. | Chip-to-chip communication system using an ac-coupled bus and devices employed in same |
US6559531B1 (en) * | 1999-10-14 | 2003-05-06 | Sun Microsystems, Inc. | Face to face chips |
US6501092B1 (en) | 1999-10-25 | 2002-12-31 | Intel Corporation | Integrated semiconductor superlattice optical modulator |
US6215577B1 (en) | 1999-10-25 | 2001-04-10 | Intel Corporation | Method and apparatus for optically modulating an optical beam with a multi-pass wave-guided optical modulator |
US6262571B1 (en) | 1999-11-17 | 2001-07-17 | Agilent Technologies, Inc. | Adjustable electrical connector for test fixture nest |
US6384617B1 (en) * | 1999-11-17 | 2002-05-07 | Agilent Technologies, Inc. | Signal transfer device for probe test fixture |
TW504779B (en) * | 1999-11-18 | 2002-10-01 | Texas Instruments Inc | Compliant wirebond pedestal |
US6320249B1 (en) * | 1999-11-30 | 2001-11-20 | Glotech, Inc. | Multiple line grids incorporating therein circuit elements |
US6268953B1 (en) | 1999-12-02 | 2001-07-31 | Intel Corporation | Method and apparatus for optically modulating an optical beam with long interaction length optical modulator |
US6351326B1 (en) | 1999-12-14 | 2002-02-26 | Intel Corporation | Method and apparatus for optically modulating light utilizing a resonant cavity structure |
US6435396B1 (en) * | 2000-04-10 | 2002-08-20 | Micron Technology, Inc. | Print head for ejecting liquid droplets |
US6878396B2 (en) | 2000-04-10 | 2005-04-12 | Micron Technology, Inc. | Micro C-4 semiconductor die and method for depositing connection sites thereon |
JP3701242B2 (en) * | 2000-04-13 | 2005-09-28 | モレックス インコーポレーテッド | Connection system |
US6612852B1 (en) | 2000-04-13 | 2003-09-02 | Molex Incorporated | Contactless interconnection system |
US6362972B1 (en) | 2000-04-13 | 2002-03-26 | Molex Incorporated | Contactless interconnection system |
US6228665B1 (en) * | 2000-06-20 | 2001-05-08 | International Business Machines Corporation | Method of measuring oxide thickness during semiconductor fabrication |
US6562641B1 (en) | 2000-08-22 | 2003-05-13 | Micron Technology, Inc. | Apparatus and methods of semiconductor packages having circuit-bearing interconnect components |
US7082007B2 (en) | 2000-09-27 | 2006-07-25 | Seagate Technology Llc | Method to achieve higher track density by allowing only one-sided track encroachment |
US6327168B1 (en) * | 2000-10-19 | 2001-12-04 | Motorola, Inc. | Single-source or single-destination signal routing through identical electronics module |
US6573801B1 (en) | 2000-11-15 | 2003-06-03 | Intel Corporation | Electromagnetic coupler |
DE20114544U1 (en) | 2000-12-04 | 2002-02-21 | Cascade Microtech, Inc., Beaverton, Oreg. | wafer probe |
WO2002061831A1 (en) * | 2001-01-24 | 2002-08-08 | Fraunhofer-Gesellschaft zur Förderung der angewandten Forschung e. V. | Method for coupling a chip to an isotropic coupling layer |
US6600325B2 (en) * | 2001-02-06 | 2003-07-29 | Sun Microsystems, Inc. | Method and apparatus for probing an integrated circuit through capacitive coupling |
JP3621354B2 (en) * | 2001-04-04 | 2005-02-16 | Necエレクトロニクス株式会社 | Wiring method and structure of semiconductor integrated circuit |
US6912330B2 (en) * | 2001-05-17 | 2005-06-28 | Sioptical Inc. | Integrated optical/electronic circuits and associated methods of simultaneous generation thereof |
US6493502B1 (en) | 2001-05-17 | 2002-12-10 | Optronx, Inc. | Dynamic gain equalizer method and associated apparatus |
US6891685B2 (en) * | 2001-05-17 | 2005-05-10 | Sioptical, Inc. | Anisotropic etching of optical components |
US6603889B2 (en) | 2001-05-17 | 2003-08-05 | Optronx, Inc. | Optical deflector apparatus and associated method |
US6608945B2 (en) | 2001-05-17 | 2003-08-19 | Optronx, Inc. | Self-aligning modulator method and associated apparatus |
US6947615B2 (en) | 2001-05-17 | 2005-09-20 | Sioptical, Inc. | Optical lens apparatus and associated method |
US6625348B2 (en) | 2001-05-17 | 2003-09-23 | Optron X, Inc. | Programmable delay generator apparatus and associated method |
US6526187B1 (en) | 2001-05-17 | 2003-02-25 | Optronx, Inc. | Polarization control apparatus and associated method |
US6748125B2 (en) | 2001-05-17 | 2004-06-08 | Sioptical, Inc. | Electronic semiconductor control of light in optical waveguide |
US6646747B2 (en) | 2001-05-17 | 2003-11-11 | Sioptical, Inc. | Interferometer apparatus and associated method |
US6492620B1 (en) * | 2001-05-18 | 2002-12-10 | Trw Inc. | Equipotential fault tolerant integrated circuit heater |
US6518673B2 (en) * | 2001-06-15 | 2003-02-11 | Trw Inc. | Capacitor for signal propagation across ground plane boundaries in superconductor integrated circuits |
WO2002103784A1 (en) * | 2001-06-16 | 2002-12-27 | Oticon A/S | Method for producing miniature amplifier and signal processing unit |
US6737879B2 (en) * | 2001-06-21 | 2004-05-18 | Morgan Labs, Llc | Method and apparatus for wafer scale testing |
DE10137668A1 (en) * | 2001-08-01 | 2002-10-17 | Infineon Technologies Ag | Component used in production of integrated circuits comprises substrate, semiconductor components connected to substrate via contacts arranged between substrate and semiconductor components, and supporting bodies |
AU2002347762B2 (en) * | 2001-08-10 | 2007-11-15 | Cabot Specialty Fluids, Inc. | Alkali metal tungstate compositions and uses thereof |
US6885090B2 (en) * | 2001-11-28 | 2005-04-26 | North Carolina State University | Inductively coupled electrical connectors |
US7279787B1 (en) * | 2001-12-31 | 2007-10-09 | Richard S. Norman | Microelectronic complex having clustered conductive members |
US7002800B2 (en) | 2002-01-25 | 2006-02-21 | Lockheed Martin Corporation | Integrated power and cooling architecture |
US6621702B2 (en) | 2002-01-25 | 2003-09-16 | Lockheed Martin Corporation | Method and apparatus for absorbing thermal energy |
JP4416373B2 (en) * | 2002-03-08 | 2010-02-17 | 株式会社日立製作所 | Electronics |
JP2005527823A (en) * | 2002-05-23 | 2005-09-15 | カスケード マイクロテック インコーポレイテッド | Probe for testing devices |
US7088198B2 (en) * | 2002-06-05 | 2006-08-08 | Intel Corporation | Controlling coupling strength in electromagnetic bus coupling |
US6812046B2 (en) * | 2002-07-29 | 2004-11-02 | Sun Microsystems Inc. | Method and apparatus for electronically aligning capacitively coupled chip pads |
US7038553B2 (en) * | 2002-10-03 | 2006-05-02 | International Business Machines Corporation | Scalable computer system having surface-mounted capacitive couplers for intercommunication |
DE10251639A1 (en) * | 2002-10-31 | 2004-05-13 | E.G.O. Elektro-Gerätebau GmbH | Sensor element device for a capacitive touch switch with an electrically conductive body and method for producing such a body |
US7480885B2 (en) * | 2002-11-18 | 2009-01-20 | Cadence Design Systems, Inc. | Method and apparatus for routing with independent goals on different layers |
US6710436B1 (en) * | 2002-12-12 | 2004-03-23 | Sun Microsystems, Inc. | Method and apparatus for electrostatically aligning integrated circuits |
US7053466B2 (en) * | 2002-12-17 | 2006-05-30 | Intel Corporation | High-speed signaling interface with broadside dynamic wave coupling |
US6855953B2 (en) * | 2002-12-20 | 2005-02-15 | Itt Manufacturing Enterprises, Inc. | Electronic circuit assembly having high contrast fiducial |
US6887095B2 (en) * | 2002-12-30 | 2005-05-03 | Intel Corporation | Electromagnetic coupler registration and mating |
US7869974B2 (en) | 2003-01-15 | 2011-01-11 | Plishner Paul J | Connector or other circuit element having an indirectly coupled integrated circuit |
JP4589921B2 (en) * | 2003-04-02 | 2010-12-01 | サン・マイクロシステムズ・インコーポレーテッド | Optical communication between facing semiconductor chips |
US6987412B2 (en) * | 2003-04-02 | 2006-01-17 | Sun Microsystems, Inc | Sense amplifying latch with low swing feedback |
US7057404B2 (en) * | 2003-05-23 | 2006-06-06 | Sharp Laboratories Of America, Inc. | Shielded probe for testing a device under test |
US7180186B2 (en) * | 2003-07-31 | 2007-02-20 | Cts Corporation | Ball grid array package |
US6946733B2 (en) * | 2003-08-13 | 2005-09-20 | Cts Corporation | Ball grid array package having testing capability after mounting |
US7319341B1 (en) * | 2003-08-28 | 2008-01-15 | Altera Corporation | Method of maintaining signal integrity across a capacitive coupled solder bump |
US7200830B2 (en) * | 2003-09-05 | 2007-04-03 | Sun Microsystems, Inc. | Enhanced electrically-aligned proximity communication |
US7148074B1 (en) | 2003-09-22 | 2006-12-12 | Sun Microsystems, Inc. | Method and apparatus for using a capacitor array to measure alignment between system components |
US6987394B1 (en) | 2003-09-22 | 2006-01-17 | Sun Microsystems, Inc. | Full-wave rectifier for capacitance measurements |
KR100960496B1 (en) * | 2003-10-31 | 2010-06-01 | 엘지디스플레이 주식회사 | Rubbing method of liquid crystal display device |
DE10351719B4 (en) | 2003-10-31 | 2012-05-24 | Ihp Gmbh - Innovations For High Performance Microelectronics / Leibniz-Institut Für Innovative Mikroelektronik | processor chip |
US7335972B2 (en) * | 2003-11-13 | 2008-02-26 | Sandia Corporation | Heterogeneously integrated microsystem-on-a-chip |
WO2005065258A2 (en) | 2003-12-24 | 2005-07-21 | Cascade Microtech, Inc. | Active wafer probe |
US7466157B2 (en) * | 2004-02-05 | 2008-12-16 | Formfactor, Inc. | Contactless interfacing of test signals with a device under test |
US7111080B2 (en) | 2004-03-01 | 2006-09-19 | Cisco Technology, Inc. | Distributing an electronic signal in a stackable device |
US8107245B1 (en) | 2004-04-02 | 2012-01-31 | Oracle America, Inc. | Proximity active connector and cable |
US7693424B1 (en) | 2004-04-02 | 2010-04-06 | Sun Microsystems, Inc. | Integrated proximity-to-optical transceiver chip |
US7067910B2 (en) * | 2004-04-13 | 2006-06-27 | Sun Microsystems, Inc. | Method and apparatus for using capacitively coupled communication within stacks of laminated chips |
US7217915B2 (en) * | 2004-05-07 | 2007-05-15 | Sun Microsystems, Inc. | Method and apparatus for detecting the position of light which is incident to a semiconductor die |
US7525199B1 (en) * | 2004-05-21 | 2009-04-28 | Sun Microsystems, Inc | Packaging for proximity communication positioned integrated circuits |
CN100527413C (en) * | 2004-06-07 | 2009-08-12 | 富士通微电子株式会社 | Capacitor built-in semiconductor device and method for manufacturing same |
WO2006011960A1 (en) * | 2004-06-25 | 2006-02-02 | Sun Microsystems, Inc. | Integrated circuit chip that supports through-chip electromagnetic communication |
US7026867B2 (en) * | 2004-06-28 | 2006-04-11 | Sun Microsystems, Inc. | Floating input amplifier for capacitively coupled communication |
WO2006019911A1 (en) * | 2004-07-26 | 2006-02-23 | Sun Microsystems, Inc. | Multi-chip module and single-chip module for chips and proximity connectors |
JP4828103B2 (en) * | 2004-07-28 | 2011-11-30 | 三菱電機株式会社 | Optical transceiver module |
DE102004038528A1 (en) * | 2004-08-07 | 2006-03-16 | Atmel Germany Gmbh | Semiconductor structure |
US7420381B2 (en) | 2004-09-13 | 2008-09-02 | Cascade Microtech, Inc. | Double sided probing structures |
EP1792344A1 (en) * | 2004-09-23 | 2007-06-06 | Technische Universität Braunschweig Carolo-Wilhelmina | Integrated circuit module and multi-chip circuit module comprising an integrated circuit module of this type |
US7538633B2 (en) * | 2004-09-28 | 2009-05-26 | Sun Microsystems, Inc. | Method and apparatus for driving on-chip wires through capacitive coupling |
US7425760B1 (en) | 2004-10-13 | 2008-09-16 | Sun Microsystems, Inc. | Multi-chip module structure with power delivery using flexible cables |
US7106079B2 (en) * | 2004-10-22 | 2006-09-12 | Sun Microsystems, Inc. | Using an interposer to facilate capacitive communication between face-to-face chips |
WO2006050446A1 (en) * | 2004-11-02 | 2006-05-11 | Sun Microsystems, Inc. | Structures and methods for proximity communication using bridge chips |
US7656172B2 (en) | 2005-01-31 | 2010-02-02 | Cascade Microtech, Inc. | System for testing semiconductors |
US7535247B2 (en) | 2005-01-31 | 2009-05-19 | Cascade Microtech, Inc. | Interface for testing semiconductors |
US8035977B1 (en) | 2005-04-04 | 2011-10-11 | Oracle America, Inc. | Apparatus for reducing power consumption by using capacitive coupling to perform majority detection |
US20060234405A1 (en) * | 2005-04-13 | 2006-10-19 | Best Scott C | Semiconductor device with self-aligning contactless interface |
US7832818B1 (en) * | 2005-05-03 | 2010-11-16 | Oracle America, Inc. | Inkjet pen with proximity interconnect |
US7384804B2 (en) * | 2005-05-09 | 2008-06-10 | Sun Microsystems, Inc. | Method and apparatus for electronically aligning capacitively coupled mini-bars |
WO2006137979A2 (en) * | 2005-06-13 | 2006-12-28 | Cascade Microtech, Inc. | Wideband active-passive differential signal probe |
US7573720B1 (en) * | 2005-06-15 | 2009-08-11 | Sun Microsystems, Inc. | Active socket for facilitating proximity communication |
US7472366B1 (en) * | 2005-08-01 | 2008-12-30 | Cadence Design Systems, Inc. | Method and apparatus for performing a path search |
US7211754B2 (en) * | 2005-08-01 | 2007-05-01 | Avago Technologies Ecbu Ip (Singapore) Pte. Ltd. | Fluid-based switch, and method of making same |
US7535105B2 (en) * | 2005-08-02 | 2009-05-19 | International Business Machines Corporation | Inter-chip ESD protection structure for high speed and high frequency devices |
EP1762943B1 (en) * | 2005-09-09 | 2014-07-09 | STMicroelectronics Srl | Chip-to-chip communication system |
US7483274B2 (en) * | 2005-09-29 | 2009-01-27 | Welch Allyn, Inc. | Galvanic isolation of a signal using capacitive coupling embedded within a circuit board |
US7450535B2 (en) * | 2005-12-01 | 2008-11-11 | Rambus Inc. | Pulsed signaling multiplexer |
US7564694B2 (en) * | 2005-12-21 | 2009-07-21 | Intel Corporation | Apparatus and method for impedance matching in a backplane signal channel |
US8756399B2 (en) * | 2006-01-25 | 2014-06-17 | Seagate Technology Llc | Mutable association of a set of logical block addresses to a band of physical storage blocks |
US7817880B1 (en) * | 2006-03-28 | 2010-10-19 | Oracle America, Inc. | Multi-chip systems using on-chip photonics |
US7304859B2 (en) * | 2006-03-30 | 2007-12-04 | Stats Chippac Ltd. | Chip carrier and fabrication method |
US7403028B2 (en) * | 2006-06-12 | 2008-07-22 | Cascade Microtech, Inc. | Test structure and probe for differential signals |
US7723999B2 (en) | 2006-06-12 | 2010-05-25 | Cascade Microtech, Inc. | Calibration structures for differential signal probing |
US7764072B2 (en) | 2006-06-12 | 2010-07-27 | Cascade Microtech, Inc. | Differential signal probing system |
US8159825B1 (en) | 2006-08-25 | 2012-04-17 | Hypres Inc. | Method for fabrication of electrical contacts to superconducting circuits |
KR100847272B1 (en) | 2006-11-28 | 2008-07-18 | 주식회사디아이 | Burn-in Board |
US7649255B2 (en) * | 2006-12-06 | 2010-01-19 | Sun Microsystems, Inc. | Determining chip separation by comparing coupling capacitances |
EP1940028B1 (en) * | 2006-12-29 | 2012-02-29 | STMicroelectronics Srl | Asynchronous interconnection system for 3D inter-chip communication |
US8208596B2 (en) * | 2007-01-17 | 2012-06-26 | Sony Corporation | System and method for implementing a dual-mode PLL to support a data transmission procedure |
WO2008111409A1 (en) | 2007-03-09 | 2008-09-18 | Nec Corporation | Semiconductor chip, and semiconductor device |
JP5149554B2 (en) * | 2007-07-17 | 2013-02-20 | 株式会社日立製作所 | Semiconductor device |
JP2009032857A (en) | 2007-07-26 | 2009-02-12 | Hitachi Ltd | Semiconductor integrated circuit, and semiconductor device |
US7876114B2 (en) | 2007-08-08 | 2011-01-25 | Cascade Microtech, Inc. | Differential waveguide probe |
US7961990B2 (en) | 2007-12-21 | 2011-06-14 | Oracle America, Inc. | Multi-chip system including capacitively coupled and optical communication |
US8320761B2 (en) | 2007-12-21 | 2012-11-27 | Oracle America, Inc. | Broadband and wavelength-selective bidirectional 3-way optical splitter |
US7889996B2 (en) | 2007-12-21 | 2011-02-15 | Oracle America, Inc. | Optical-signal-path routing in a multi-chip system |
WO2009096254A1 (en) * | 2008-01-28 | 2009-08-06 | Murata Manufacturing Co., Ltd. | Semiconductor integrated circuit device, structure for mounting semiconductor integrated circuit device and method for manufacturing semiconductor integrated circuit device |
US7979754B2 (en) * | 2008-01-30 | 2011-07-12 | Oracle America, Inc. | Voltage margin testing for proximity communication |
US7795700B2 (en) * | 2008-02-28 | 2010-09-14 | Broadcom Corporation | Inductively coupled integrated circuit with magnetic communication path and methods for use therewith |
US20090259772A1 (en) * | 2008-04-11 | 2009-10-15 | Nokia Corporation | Apparatus for a user removable memory or a device for communication with a user removable memory, and associated methods |
JP4561870B2 (en) * | 2008-05-14 | 2010-10-13 | 株式会社デンソー | Electronic device and manufacturing method thereof |
US20090317033A1 (en) * | 2008-06-20 | 2009-12-24 | Industrial Technology Research Institute | Integrated circuit and photonic board thereof |
JP5211948B2 (en) * | 2008-09-04 | 2013-06-12 | ソニー株式会社 | Integrated device and electronic equipment |
JP2010109132A (en) * | 2008-10-30 | 2010-05-13 | Yamaha Corp | Thermoelectric module package and method of manufacturing the same |
US8024623B2 (en) * | 2008-11-03 | 2011-09-20 | Oracle America, Inc. | Misalignment compensation for proximity communication |
JP5556072B2 (en) | 2009-01-07 | 2014-07-23 | ソニー株式会社 | Semiconductor device, method of manufacturing the same, and millimeter wave dielectric transmission device |
EP2693641A1 (en) * | 2009-02-12 | 2014-02-05 | Mosaid Technologies Incorporated | Termination circuit for on-die termination |
US8026111B2 (en) * | 2009-02-24 | 2011-09-27 | Oracle America, Inc. | Dielectric enhancements to chip-to-chip capacitive proximity communication |
JP5578797B2 (en) * | 2009-03-13 | 2014-08-27 | ルネサスエレクトロニクス株式会社 | Semiconductor device |
JP5476829B2 (en) * | 2009-07-17 | 2014-04-23 | 富士ゼロックス株式会社 | Semiconductor integrated circuit device |
US8254142B2 (en) * | 2009-09-22 | 2012-08-28 | Wintec Industries, Inc. | Method of using conductive elastomer for electrical contacts in an assembly |
EP2309829A1 (en) * | 2009-09-24 | 2011-04-13 | Harman Becker Automotive Systems GmbH | Multilayer circuit board |
US8618629B2 (en) * | 2009-10-08 | 2013-12-31 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Apparatus and method for through silicon via impedance matching |
US8593825B2 (en) * | 2009-10-14 | 2013-11-26 | Wintec Industries, Inc. | Apparatus and method for vertically-structured passive components |
US8350638B2 (en) * | 2009-11-20 | 2013-01-08 | General Motors Llc | Connector assembly for providing capacitive coupling between a body and a coplanar waveguide and method of assembling |
US8472437B2 (en) * | 2010-02-15 | 2013-06-25 | Texas Instruments Incorporated | Wireless chip-to-chip switching |
US8278756B2 (en) * | 2010-02-24 | 2012-10-02 | Inpaq Technology Co., Ltd. | Single chip semiconductor coating structure and manufacturing method thereof |
US20110316139A1 (en) * | 2010-06-23 | 2011-12-29 | Broadcom Corporation | Package for a wireless enabled integrated circuit |
US8340576B2 (en) * | 2010-06-29 | 2012-12-25 | Stmicroelectronics S.R.L. | Electronic circuit for communicating through capacitive coupling |
US8150315B2 (en) * | 2010-06-29 | 2012-04-03 | Stmicroelectronics S.R.L. | Method for verifying the alignment between integrated electronic devices |
US8686906B2 (en) | 2010-09-20 | 2014-04-01 | GM Global Technology Operations LLC | Microwave antenna assemblies |
US9077072B2 (en) | 2010-09-20 | 2015-07-07 | General Motors Llc | Antenna system and filter |
US20120086114A1 (en) * | 2010-10-07 | 2012-04-12 | Broadcom Corporation | Millimeter devices on an integrated circuit |
US20120091575A1 (en) * | 2010-10-15 | 2012-04-19 | Yi-Shao Lai | Semiconductor Package And Method For Making The Same |
TW201221041A (en) * | 2010-11-11 | 2012-05-16 | Hon Hai Prec Ind Co Ltd | Heat dissipation apparatus assembly |
US8492658B2 (en) | 2010-11-16 | 2013-07-23 | International Business Machines Corporation | Laminate capacitor stack inside a printed circuit board for electromagnetic compatibility capacitance |
US8704719B2 (en) | 2010-11-23 | 2014-04-22 | General Motors Llc | Multi-function antenna |
US8848390B2 (en) | 2011-02-16 | 2014-09-30 | Taiwan Semiconductor Manufacturing Co., Ltd. | Capacitive proximity communication using tuned-inductor |
US8901945B2 (en) | 2011-02-23 | 2014-12-02 | Broadcom Corporation | Test board for use with devices having wirelessly enabled functional blocks and method of using same |
US9147636B2 (en) | 2011-06-29 | 2015-09-29 | Stmicroelectronics S.R.L. | Method for verifying the alignment between integrated electronic devices |
EP2745655B1 (en) * | 2011-08-15 | 2015-10-07 | SMA Solar Technology AG | Electronic device comprising a capacitor in a holder for a circuit board and method for production thereof |
US8928139B2 (en) * | 2011-09-30 | 2015-01-06 | Broadcom Corporation | Device having wirelessly enabled functional blocks |
US9076663B2 (en) * | 2011-10-05 | 2015-07-07 | Oracle International Corporation | Determining spacing using a spatially varying charge distribution |
CN103858358B (en) * | 2011-10-10 | 2017-04-12 | 罗斯蒂斯莱夫·沃洛迪米洛维奇·博森科 | Method for wirelessly transmitting a data stream between a transmitting apparatus and a receiving apparatus and a wireless transmission system with the transmitting apparatus and the receiving apparatus |
US9355362B2 (en) * | 2011-11-11 | 2016-05-31 | Northrop Grumman Systems Corporation | Quantum bits and method of forming the same |
US9912448B2 (en) * | 2012-02-13 | 2018-03-06 | Sentinel Connector Systems, Inc. | Testing apparatus for a high speed communications jack and methods of operating the same |
US9947609B2 (en) | 2012-03-09 | 2018-04-17 | Honeywell International Inc. | Integrated circuit stack |
UA107197C2 (en) | 2012-04-04 | 2014-12-10 | SYSTEMS, METHODS AND APPARATUS OF WIRELESS CAPACITY RECEIVING SIGNALS WITH CHANNEL DISTRIBUTION (OPTIONS) | |
US8779789B2 (en) * | 2012-04-09 | 2014-07-15 | Advanced Inquiry Systems, Inc. | Translators coupleable to opposing surfaces of microelectronic substrates for testing, and associated systems and methods |
US9431168B2 (en) * | 2012-06-13 | 2016-08-30 | Advanced Micro Devices, Inc. | Contactless interconnect |
US9148975B2 (en) | 2012-06-22 | 2015-09-29 | Advanced Micro Devices, Inc. | Electronic interconnect method and apparatus |
US10285270B2 (en) * | 2012-09-07 | 2019-05-07 | Joseph Fjelstad | Solder alloy free electronic (safe) rigid-flexible/stretchable circuit assemblies having integral, conductive and heat spreading sections and methods for their manufacture |
US9536833B2 (en) | 2013-02-01 | 2017-01-03 | Mediatek Inc. | Semiconductor device allowing metal layer routing formed directly under metal pad |
US9455226B2 (en) * | 2013-02-01 | 2016-09-27 | Mediatek Inc. | Semiconductor device allowing metal layer routing formed directly under metal pad |
US9041205B2 (en) * | 2013-06-28 | 2015-05-26 | Intel Corporation | Reliable microstrip routing for electronics components |
GB2518363A (en) * | 2013-09-18 | 2015-03-25 | Novalia Ltd | Circuit board assembly |
US9826662B2 (en) * | 2013-12-12 | 2017-11-21 | General Electric Company | Reusable phase-change thermal interface structures |
FR3015781B1 (en) * | 2013-12-20 | 2016-02-05 | Thales Sa | HYPERFREQUENCY INTERCONNECTION DEVICE |
US10168425B2 (en) | 2014-07-03 | 2019-01-01 | GM Global Technology Operations LLC | Centralized vehicle radar methods and systems |
US9728489B2 (en) | 2014-10-29 | 2017-08-08 | Elwha Llc | Systems, methods and devices for inter-substrate coupling |
US9887177B2 (en) | 2014-10-29 | 2018-02-06 | Elwha Llc | Systems, methods and devices for inter-substrate coupling |
US9893026B2 (en) | 2014-10-29 | 2018-02-13 | Elwha Llc | Systems, methods and devices for inter-substrate coupling |
US10140407B2 (en) | 2014-11-26 | 2018-11-27 | Taiwan Semiconductor Manufacturing Company, Ltd. | Method, device and computer program product for integrated circuit layout generation |
US9515017B2 (en) * | 2014-12-18 | 2016-12-06 | Intel Corporation | Ground via clustering for crosstalk mitigation |
US9799575B2 (en) | 2015-12-16 | 2017-10-24 | Pdf Solutions, Inc. | Integrated circuit containing DOEs of NCEM-enabled fill cells |
US10199283B1 (en) | 2015-02-03 | 2019-02-05 | Pdf Solutions, Inc. | Method for processing a semiconductor wager using non-contact electrical measurements indicative of a resistance through a stitch, where such measurements are obtained by scanning a pad comprised of at least three parallel conductive stripes using a moving stage with beam deflection to account for motion of the stage |
US9548277B2 (en) | 2015-04-21 | 2017-01-17 | Honeywell International Inc. | Integrated circuit stack including a patterned array of electrically conductive pillars |
US20160322265A1 (en) * | 2015-04-30 | 2016-11-03 | Globalfoundries Inc. | Method and apparatus for detection of failures in under-fill layers in integrated circuit assemblies |
US10978438B1 (en) | 2015-12-16 | 2021-04-13 | Pdf Solutions, Inc. | IC with test structures and E-beam pads embedded within a contiguous standard cell area |
US10593604B1 (en) | 2015-12-16 | 2020-03-17 | Pdf Solutions, Inc. | Process for making semiconductor dies, chips, and wafers using in-line measurements obtained from DOEs of NCEM-enabled fill cells |
WO2017138106A1 (en) * | 2016-02-10 | 2017-08-17 | ウルトラメモリ株式会社 | Semiconductor device |
CN105759142B (en) * | 2016-02-22 | 2018-06-29 | 广东小天才科技有限公司 | Method and system for calibrating skin capacitance threshold of wearable device |
US11211305B2 (en) | 2016-04-01 | 2021-12-28 | Texas Instruments Incorporated | Apparatus and method to support thermal management of semiconductor-based components |
US9929063B1 (en) | 2016-04-04 | 2018-03-27 | Pdf Solutions, Inc. | Process for making an integrated circuit that includes NCEM-Enabled, tip-to-side gap-configured fill cells, with NCEM pads formed from at least three conductive stripes positioned between adjacent gates |
US9627370B1 (en) | 2016-04-04 | 2017-04-18 | Pdf Solutions, Inc. | Integrated circuit containing standard logic cells and library-compatible, NCEM-enabled fill cells, including at least via-open-configured, GATE-short-configured, GATECNT-short-configured, and TS-short-configured, NCEM-enabled fill cells |
US9905553B1 (en) | 2016-04-04 | 2018-02-27 | Pdf Solutions, Inc. | Integrated circuit containing standard logic cells and library-compatible, NCEM-enabled fill cells, including at least via-open-configured, AACNT-short-configured, GATECNT-short-configured, and metal-short-configured, NCEM-enabled fill cells |
US10861796B2 (en) | 2016-05-10 | 2020-12-08 | Texas Instruments Incorporated | Floating die package |
JP6524986B2 (en) | 2016-09-16 | 2019-06-05 | 株式会社村田製作所 | High frequency module, substrate with antenna, and high frequency circuit substrate |
JP6589788B2 (en) * | 2016-09-21 | 2019-10-16 | 株式会社デンソー | Electronic control unit |
US10179730B2 (en) | 2016-12-08 | 2019-01-15 | Texas Instruments Incorporated | Electronic sensors with sensor die in package structure cavity |
EP3555909A4 (en) * | 2016-12-16 | 2020-09-16 | Tesoro Scientific, Inc. | Light emitting diode (led) test apparatus and method of manufacture |
US9929110B1 (en) | 2016-12-30 | 2018-03-27 | Texas Instruments Incorporated | Integrated circuit wave device and method |
US10074639B2 (en) | 2016-12-30 | 2018-09-11 | Texas Instruments Incorporated | Isolator integrated circuits with package structure cavity and fabrication methods |
US10411150B2 (en) | 2016-12-30 | 2019-09-10 | Texas Instruments Incorporated | Optical isolation systems and circuits and photon detectors with extended lateral P-N junctions |
JP2020506541A (en) | 2017-01-23 | 2020-02-27 | テソロ・サイエンティフィック・インコーポレーテッド | Light emitting diode (LED) inspection apparatus and manufacturing method |
US10121847B2 (en) | 2017-03-17 | 2018-11-06 | Texas Instruments Incorporated | Galvanic isolation device |
US9748153B1 (en) | 2017-03-29 | 2017-08-29 | Pdf Solutions, Inc. | Process for making and using a semiconductor wafer containing first and second does of standard cell compatible, NCEM-enabled fill cells, with the first DOE including side-to-side short configured fill cells, and the second DOE including tip-to-side short configure |
US9773774B1 (en) | 2017-03-30 | 2017-09-26 | Pdf Solutions, Inc. | Process for making and using a semiconductor wafer containing first and second DOEs of standard cell compatible, NCEM-enabled fill cells, with the first DOE including chamfer short configured fill cells, and the second DOE including corner short configured fill cells |
US10147676B1 (en) | 2017-05-15 | 2018-12-04 | International Business Machines Corporation | Wafer-scale power delivery |
JP7258781B2 (en) | 2017-06-20 | 2023-04-17 | アップル インコーポレイテッド | Light Emitting Diode (LED) Test Apparatus and Manufacturing Method |
US9786649B1 (en) | 2017-06-27 | 2017-10-10 | Pdf Solutions, Inc. | Process for making and using a semiconductor wafer containing first and second DOEs of standard cell compatible, NCEM-enabled fill cells, with the first DOE including via open configured fill cells, and the second DOE including stitch open configured fill cells |
US9768083B1 (en) | 2017-06-27 | 2017-09-19 | Pdf Solutions, Inc. | Process for making and using a semiconductor wafer containing first and second DOEs of standard cell compatible, NCEM-enabled fill cells, with the first DOE including merged-via open configured fill cells, and the second DOE including snake open configured fill cells |
US9865583B1 (en) | 2017-06-28 | 2018-01-09 | Pdf Solutions, Inc. | Process for making and using a semiconductor wafer containing first and second DOEs of standard cell compatible, NCEM-enabled fill cells, with the first DOE including snake open configured fill cells, and the second DOE including stitch open configured fill cells |
US10096530B1 (en) | 2017-06-28 | 2018-10-09 | Pdf Solutions, Inc. | Process for making and using a semiconductor wafer containing first and second DOEs of standard cell compatible, NCEM-enabled fill cells, with the first DOE including merged-via open configured fill cells, and the second DOE including stitch open configured fill cells |
IL275963B1 (en) * | 2018-01-10 | 2024-09-01 | Adagio Medical Inc | Cryoablation element with conductive liner |
CN110098156B (en) * | 2018-01-29 | 2023-04-18 | 光宝新加坡有限公司 | Capacitive coupling packaging structure for capacitive coupling isolator |
US10621387B2 (en) | 2018-05-30 | 2020-04-14 | Seagate Technology Llc | On-die decoupling capacitor area optimization |
US20200103870A1 (en) * | 2018-10-02 | 2020-04-02 | Austin Small | Automated breadboard wiring assembly |
US11830804B2 (en) * | 2019-04-02 | 2023-11-28 | Invensas Llc | Over and under interconnects |
US10517174B1 (en) * | 2019-05-01 | 2019-12-24 | Joseph Charles Fjelstad | Solder alloy free electronic (SAFE) rigid-flexible/stretchable circuit assemblies having integral, conductive and heat spreading sections and methods for their manufacture |
US11183452B1 (en) | 2020-08-12 | 2021-11-23 | Infineon Technologies Austria Ag | Transfering informations across a high voltage gap using capacitive coupling with DTI integrated in silicon technology |
US11476707B2 (en) | 2020-10-06 | 2022-10-18 | Apple Inc. | Wireless power system housing |
US11750189B2 (en) | 2020-12-24 | 2023-09-05 | International Business Machines Corporation | Programmable and reprogrammable quantum circuit |
CN115598427B (en) * | 2022-12-14 | 2023-03-14 | 四川斯艾普电子科技有限公司 | Coupling detector based on thick film and thin film integration and implementation method thereof |
Citations (47)
Publication number | Priority date | Publication date | Assignee | Title |
---|---|---|---|---|
US3584287A (en) * | 1968-10-02 | 1971-06-08 | S K V Sa | High-voltage direct-current generator |
US3613033A (en) * | 1964-09-02 | 1971-10-12 | Peter A Denes | Broad-band high-frequency low-pass filters |
US3794759A (en) * | 1972-12-26 | 1974-02-26 | Ibm | Multi-terminal communication apparatus controller |
US3983546A (en) * | 1972-06-30 | 1976-09-28 | International Business Machines Corporation | Phase-to-pulse conversion circuits incorporating Josephson devices and superconducting interconnection circuitry |
US4339668A (en) * | 1978-09-28 | 1982-07-13 | Siemens Aktiengesellschaft | Monolithically integrated circuit of high dielectric strength for electrically coupling isolated circuits |
US4349862A (en) * | 1980-08-11 | 1982-09-14 | International Business Machines Corporation | Capacitive chip carrier and multilayer ceramic capacitors |
US4376921A (en) * | 1981-04-28 | 1983-03-15 | Westinghouse Electric Corp. | Microwave coupler with high isolation and high directivity |
US4605915A (en) * | 1984-07-09 | 1986-08-12 | Cubic Corporation | Stripline circuits isolated by adjacent decoupling strip portions |
US4633035A (en) * | 1982-07-12 | 1986-12-30 | Rogers Corporation | Microwave circuit boards |
US4640866A (en) * | 1984-04-10 | 1987-02-03 | Junkosha Company Ltd. | Printed circuit board |
US4642569A (en) * | 1983-12-16 | 1987-02-10 | General Electric Company | Shield for decoupling RF and gradient coils in an NMR apparatus |
US4654581A (en) * | 1983-10-12 | 1987-03-31 | Hewlett-Packard Company | Capacitive mask aligner |
US4675717A (en) * | 1984-10-09 | 1987-06-23 | American Telephone And Telegraph Company, At&T Bell Laboratories | Water-scale-integrated assembly |
US4775573A (en) * | 1987-04-03 | 1988-10-04 | West-Tronics, Inc. | Multilayer PC board using polymer thick films |
US4812885A (en) * | 1987-08-04 | 1989-03-14 | Texas Instruments Incorporated | Capacitive coupling |
US4876535A (en) * | 1986-09-06 | 1989-10-24 | Zeiss Ikon Ag | Method and apparatus for non-contacting information transmission |
US4931991A (en) * | 1988-12-22 | 1990-06-05 | Amp Incorporated | Machine readable memory card with capacitive interconnect |
US4982311A (en) * | 1987-09-29 | 1991-01-01 | Bull S.A. | Package for very large scale integrated circuit |
US4999593A (en) * | 1989-06-02 | 1991-03-12 | Motorola, Inc. | Capacitively compensated microstrip directional coupler |
US5012321A (en) * | 1983-07-29 | 1991-04-30 | Thomson-Csf | Interconnection device between the cells of a pre-implanted hyperfrequency integrated circuit |
US5027253A (en) * | 1990-04-09 | 1991-06-25 | Ibm Corporation | Printed circuit boards and cards having buried thin film capacitors and processing techniques for fabricating said boards and cards |
US5037761A (en) * | 1987-09-03 | 1991-08-06 | Elsag International B.V. | Method of applying an automotive type oxygen sensor for use in an industrial process analyzer |
US5103283A (en) * | 1989-01-17 | 1992-04-07 | Hite Larry R | Packaged integrated circuit with in-cavity decoupling capacitors |
US5119172A (en) * | 1991-03-04 | 1992-06-02 | Motorola, Inc. | Microelectronic device package employing capacitively coupled connections |
US5138436A (en) * | 1990-11-16 | 1992-08-11 | Ball Corporation | Interconnect package having means for waveguide transmission of rf signals |
US5155655A (en) * | 1989-08-23 | 1992-10-13 | Zycon Corporation | Capacitor laminate for use in capacitive printed circuit boards and methods of manufacture |
US5155656A (en) * | 1991-12-12 | 1992-10-13 | Micron Technology, Inc. | Integrated series capacitors for high reliability electronic applications including decoupling circuits |
US5270485A (en) * | 1991-01-28 | 1993-12-14 | Sarcos Group | High density, three-dimensional, intercoupled circuit structure |
US5269882A (en) * | 1991-01-28 | 1993-12-14 | Sarcos Group | Method and apparatus for fabrication of thin film semiconductor devices using non-planar, exposure beam lithography |
US5272600A (en) * | 1992-09-02 | 1993-12-21 | Microelectronics And Computer Technology Corporation | Electrical interconnect device with interwoven power and ground lines and capacitive vias |
US5309122A (en) * | 1992-10-28 | 1994-05-03 | Ball Corporation | Multiple-layer microstrip assembly with inter-layer connections |
US5356484A (en) * | 1992-03-30 | 1994-10-18 | Yater Joseph C | Reversible thermoelectric converter |
US5365205A (en) * | 1993-05-20 | 1994-11-15 | Northern Telecom Limited | Backplane databus utilizing directional couplers |
US5376904A (en) * | 1993-05-20 | 1994-12-27 | Northern Telecom Limited | Directional coupler for differentially driven twisted line |
US5404265A (en) * | 1992-08-28 | 1995-04-04 | Fujitsu Limited | Interconnect capacitors |
US5432486A (en) * | 1993-05-20 | 1995-07-11 | Northern Telecom Limited | Capacitive and inductive coupling connector |
US5629838A (en) * | 1993-06-24 | 1997-05-13 | Polychip, Inc. | Apparatus for non-conductively interconnecting integrated circuits using half capacitors |
US5638402A (en) * | 1993-09-27 | 1997-06-10 | Hitachi, Ltd. | Fast data transfer bus |
US5673131A (en) * | 1991-12-31 | 1997-09-30 | Sarcos Group | High density, three-dimensional, intercoupled circuit structure |
US5786979A (en) * | 1995-12-18 | 1998-07-28 | Douglass; Barry G. | High density inter-chip connections by electromagnetic coupling |
US5854480A (en) * | 1995-07-18 | 1998-12-29 | Oki Electric Indusry Co., Ltd. | Tag with IC capacitively coupled to antenna |
US5863832A (en) * | 1996-06-28 | 1999-01-26 | Intel Corporation | Capping layer in interconnect system and method for bonding the capping layer onto the interconnect system |
US6081030A (en) * | 1997-06-27 | 2000-06-27 | Stmicroelectronics S.A. | Semiconductor device having separated exchange means |
US6310400B1 (en) * | 1997-12-29 | 2001-10-30 | Intel Corporation | Apparatus for capacitively coupling electronic devices |
US6496359B2 (en) * | 2000-12-08 | 2002-12-17 | Sun Microsystems, Inc. | Tile array computers |
US6500696B2 (en) * | 1999-10-14 | 2002-12-31 | Sun Microsystems, Inc. | Face to face chip |
US6600325B2 (en) * | 2001-02-06 | 2003-07-29 | Sun Microsystems, Inc. | Method and apparatus for probing an integrated circuit through capacitive coupling |
Family Cites Families (12)
Publication number | Priority date | Publication date | Assignee | Title |
---|---|---|---|---|
DE2902002A1 (en) | 1979-01-19 | 1980-07-31 | Gerhard Krause | Three=dimensional integrated circuits - mfd. by joining wafer stack with contacts through conductive adhesive |
EP0048287A1 (en) | 1980-09-18 | 1982-03-31 | Pusch, Günter, Dr.-Ing. | Process for manufacturing a heat-reflecting wall-paper or covering |
GB2157110B (en) * | 1984-03-08 | 1987-11-04 | Oxley Dev Co Ltd | Filters for electronic circuits |
JPS6315435A (en) * | 1986-07-08 | 1988-01-22 | Fujitsu Ltd | Package for semiconductor device |
US4920343A (en) * | 1988-09-30 | 1990-04-24 | Honeywell Inc. | Capacitive keyswitch membrane with self contained sense-to-ground capacitance |
US5043859A (en) * | 1989-12-21 | 1991-08-27 | General Electric Company | Half bridge device package, packaged devices and circuits |
US5151806A (en) * | 1990-04-27 | 1992-09-29 | Mitsubishi Denki Kabushiki Kaisha | Liquid crystal display apparatus having a series combination of the storage capacitors |
US5073761A (en) | 1990-06-05 | 1991-12-17 | Westinghouse Electric Corp. | Non-contacting radio frequency coupler connector |
IT222913Z2 (en) | 1991-02-08 | 1995-05-09 | Skf Ind Spa | PROTECTIVE SHELL WITH RETURN APPENDIX AND CABLE CONNECTOR |
US5404285A (en) * | 1991-07-03 | 1995-04-04 | Schonbek Worldwide Lighting Inc. | Chandelier with interlocking modular glassware |
JPH0583011A (en) | 1991-09-25 | 1993-04-02 | Sumitomo Electric Ind Ltd | Input/output coupling device for package for semiconductor device |
JP3197983B2 (en) | 1993-05-06 | 2001-08-13 | 山中産業株式会社 | Palatable beverage or seasoning extraction bag |
-
1993
- 1993-06-24 US US08/082,328 patent/US6728113B1/en not_active Expired - Lifetime
-
1994
- 1994-06-24 EP EP94922031A patent/EP0705529A4/en not_active Withdrawn
- 1994-06-24 US US08/265,607 patent/US5629838A/en not_active Expired - Lifetime
- 1994-06-24 JP JP50312795A patent/JP4017186B2/en not_active Expired - Lifetime
- 1994-06-24 WO PCT/US1994/007238 patent/WO1995001087A1/en not_active Application Discontinuation
-
1999
- 1999-12-10 US US09/459,108 patent/US6916719B1/en not_active Expired - Fee Related
-
2004
- 2004-04-27 US US10/834,352 patent/US20050002448A1/en not_active Abandoned
- 2004-04-28 JP JP2004134264A patent/JP4083704B2/en not_active Expired - Lifetime
-
2008
- 2008-01-17 US US12/015,720 patent/US7869221B2/en not_active Expired - Fee Related
Patent Citations (49)
Publication number | Priority date | Publication date | Assignee | Title |
---|---|---|---|---|
US3613033A (en) * | 1964-09-02 | 1971-10-12 | Peter A Denes | Broad-band high-frequency low-pass filters |
US3584287A (en) * | 1968-10-02 | 1971-06-08 | S K V Sa | High-voltage direct-current generator |
US3983546A (en) * | 1972-06-30 | 1976-09-28 | International Business Machines Corporation | Phase-to-pulse conversion circuits incorporating Josephson devices and superconducting interconnection circuitry |
US3794759A (en) * | 1972-12-26 | 1974-02-26 | Ibm | Multi-terminal communication apparatus controller |
US4339668A (en) * | 1978-09-28 | 1982-07-13 | Siemens Aktiengesellschaft | Monolithically integrated circuit of high dielectric strength for electrically coupling isolated circuits |
US4349862A (en) * | 1980-08-11 | 1982-09-14 | International Business Machines Corporation | Capacitive chip carrier and multilayer ceramic capacitors |
US4376921A (en) * | 1981-04-28 | 1983-03-15 | Westinghouse Electric Corp. | Microwave coupler with high isolation and high directivity |
US4633035A (en) * | 1982-07-12 | 1986-12-30 | Rogers Corporation | Microwave circuit boards |
US5012321A (en) * | 1983-07-29 | 1991-04-30 | Thomson-Csf | Interconnection device between the cells of a pre-implanted hyperfrequency integrated circuit |
US4654581A (en) * | 1983-10-12 | 1987-03-31 | Hewlett-Packard Company | Capacitive mask aligner |
US4642569A (en) * | 1983-12-16 | 1987-02-10 | General Electric Company | Shield for decoupling RF and gradient coils in an NMR apparatus |
US4640866A (en) * | 1984-04-10 | 1987-02-03 | Junkosha Company Ltd. | Printed circuit board |
US4605915A (en) * | 1984-07-09 | 1986-08-12 | Cubic Corporation | Stripline circuits isolated by adjacent decoupling strip portions |
US4675717A (en) * | 1984-10-09 | 1987-06-23 | American Telephone And Telegraph Company, At&T Bell Laboratories | Water-scale-integrated assembly |
US4876535A (en) * | 1986-09-06 | 1989-10-24 | Zeiss Ikon Ag | Method and apparatus for non-contacting information transmission |
US4775573A (en) * | 1987-04-03 | 1988-10-04 | West-Tronics, Inc. | Multilayer PC board using polymer thick films |
US4812885A (en) * | 1987-08-04 | 1989-03-14 | Texas Instruments Incorporated | Capacitive coupling |
US5037761A (en) * | 1987-09-03 | 1991-08-06 | Elsag International B.V. | Method of applying an automotive type oxygen sensor for use in an industrial process analyzer |
US4982311A (en) * | 1987-09-29 | 1991-01-01 | Bull S.A. | Package for very large scale integrated circuit |
US4931991A (en) * | 1988-12-22 | 1990-06-05 | Amp Incorporated | Machine readable memory card with capacitive interconnect |
US5103283A (en) * | 1989-01-17 | 1992-04-07 | Hite Larry R | Packaged integrated circuit with in-cavity decoupling capacitors |
US4999593A (en) * | 1989-06-02 | 1991-03-12 | Motorola, Inc. | Capacitively compensated microstrip directional coupler |
US5155655A (en) * | 1989-08-23 | 1992-10-13 | Zycon Corporation | Capacitor laminate for use in capacitive printed circuit boards and methods of manufacture |
US5027253A (en) * | 1990-04-09 | 1991-06-25 | Ibm Corporation | Printed circuit boards and cards having buried thin film capacitors and processing techniques for fabricating said boards and cards |
US5138436A (en) * | 1990-11-16 | 1992-08-11 | Ball Corporation | Interconnect package having means for waveguide transmission of rf signals |
US5270485A (en) * | 1991-01-28 | 1993-12-14 | Sarcos Group | High density, three-dimensional, intercoupled circuit structure |
US5269882A (en) * | 1991-01-28 | 1993-12-14 | Sarcos Group | Method and apparatus for fabrication of thin film semiconductor devices using non-planar, exposure beam lithography |
US5119172A (en) * | 1991-03-04 | 1992-06-02 | Motorola, Inc. | Microelectronic device package employing capacitively coupled connections |
US5155656A (en) * | 1991-12-12 | 1992-10-13 | Micron Technology, Inc. | Integrated series capacitors for high reliability electronic applications including decoupling circuits |
US5673131A (en) * | 1991-12-31 | 1997-09-30 | Sarcos Group | High density, three-dimensional, intercoupled circuit structure |
US5356484A (en) * | 1992-03-30 | 1994-10-18 | Yater Joseph C | Reversible thermoelectric converter |
US5404265A (en) * | 1992-08-28 | 1995-04-04 | Fujitsu Limited | Interconnect capacitors |
US5272600A (en) * | 1992-09-02 | 1993-12-21 | Microelectronics And Computer Technology Corporation | Electrical interconnect device with interwoven power and ground lines and capacitive vias |
US5309122A (en) * | 1992-10-28 | 1994-05-03 | Ball Corporation | Multiple-layer microstrip assembly with inter-layer connections |
US5365205A (en) * | 1993-05-20 | 1994-11-15 | Northern Telecom Limited | Backplane databus utilizing directional couplers |
US5376904A (en) * | 1993-05-20 | 1994-12-27 | Northern Telecom Limited | Directional coupler for differentially driven twisted line |
US5432486A (en) * | 1993-05-20 | 1995-07-11 | Northern Telecom Limited | Capacitive and inductive coupling connector |
US6728113B1 (en) * | 1993-06-24 | 2004-04-27 | Polychip, Inc. | Method and apparatus for non-conductively interconnecting integrated circuits |
US5629838A (en) * | 1993-06-24 | 1997-05-13 | Polychip, Inc. | Apparatus for non-conductively interconnecting integrated circuits using half capacitors |
US5638402A (en) * | 1993-09-27 | 1997-06-10 | Hitachi, Ltd. | Fast data transfer bus |
US5854480A (en) * | 1995-07-18 | 1998-12-29 | Oki Electric Indusry Co., Ltd. | Tag with IC capacitively coupled to antenna |
US5786979A (en) * | 1995-12-18 | 1998-07-28 | Douglass; Barry G. | High density inter-chip connections by electromagnetic coupling |
US5863832A (en) * | 1996-06-28 | 1999-01-26 | Intel Corporation | Capping layer in interconnect system and method for bonding the capping layer onto the interconnect system |
US6081030A (en) * | 1997-06-27 | 2000-06-27 | Stmicroelectronics S.A. | Semiconductor device having separated exchange means |
US6310400B1 (en) * | 1997-12-29 | 2001-10-30 | Intel Corporation | Apparatus for capacitively coupling electronic devices |
US6500696B2 (en) * | 1999-10-14 | 2002-12-31 | Sun Microsystems, Inc. | Face to face chip |
US6559531B1 (en) * | 1999-10-14 | 2003-05-06 | Sun Microsystems, Inc. | Face to face chips |
US6496359B2 (en) * | 2000-12-08 | 2002-12-17 | Sun Microsystems, Inc. | Tile array computers |
US6600325B2 (en) * | 2001-02-06 | 2003-07-29 | Sun Microsystems, Inc. | Method and apparatus for probing an integrated circuit through capacitive coupling |
Cited By (37)
Publication number | Priority date | Publication date | Assignee | Title |
---|---|---|---|---|
US8049331B2 (en) | 2003-10-13 | 2011-11-01 | Micron Technology, Inc. | Structure and method for forming a capacitively coupled chip-to-chip signaling interface |
US20050077546A1 (en) * | 2003-10-13 | 2005-04-14 | Philip Neaves | Structure and method for forming a capacitively coupled chip-to-chip signaling interface |
US7462935B2 (en) * | 2003-10-13 | 2008-12-09 | Micron Technology, Inc. | Structure and method for forming a capacitively coupled chip-to-chip signaling interface |
US20090072389A1 (en) * | 2003-10-13 | 2009-03-19 | Micron Technology, Inc. | Structure and method for forming a capacitively coupled chip-to-chip signaling interface |
US20100283158A1 (en) * | 2003-10-13 | 2010-11-11 | Micron Technology, Inc. | Structure and method for forming a capacitively coupled chip-to-chip signaling interface |
US7763497B2 (en) | 2003-10-13 | 2010-07-27 | Micron Technology, Inc. | Structure and method for forming a capacitively coupled chip-to-chip signaling interface |
US10491748B1 (en) | 2006-04-03 | 2019-11-26 | Wai Wu | Intelligent communication routing system and method |
US20080128916A1 (en) * | 2006-12-04 | 2008-06-05 | Nec Electronics Corporation | Semiconductor device including microstrip line and coplanar line |
US20100203677A1 (en) * | 2007-05-17 | 2010-08-12 | Chua Swee Kwang | Method for fabricating semiconductor packages with discrete components |
US7807502B2 (en) | 2007-05-17 | 2010-10-05 | Micron Technology, Inc. | Method for fabricating semiconductor packages with discrete components |
US7723831B2 (en) | 2007-05-17 | 2010-05-25 | Micron Technology, Inc. | Semiconductor package having die with recess and discrete component embedded within the recess |
US20080284003A1 (en) * | 2007-05-17 | 2008-11-20 | Chua Swee Kwang | Semiconductor Packages And Method For Fabricating Semiconductor Packages With Discrete Components |
US20110012253A1 (en) * | 2007-05-17 | 2011-01-20 | Chua Swee Kwang | Semiconductor Package Having Discrete Components And System Containing The Package |
US7964946B2 (en) | 2007-05-17 | 2011-06-21 | Micron Technology, Inc. | Semiconductor package having discrete components and system containing the package |
US20110215438A1 (en) * | 2007-05-17 | 2011-09-08 | Chua Swee Kwang | Stacked Semiconductor Package Having Discrete Components |
US8174105B2 (en) | 2007-05-17 | 2012-05-08 | Micron Technology, Inc. | Stacked semiconductor package having discrete components |
US8415777B2 (en) * | 2008-02-29 | 2013-04-09 | Broadcom Corporation | Integrated circuit with millimeter wave and inductive coupling and methods for use therewith |
US20090218407A1 (en) * | 2008-02-29 | 2009-09-03 | Broadcom Corporation | Integrated circuit with millimeter wave and inductive coupling and methods for use therewith |
US20110215472A1 (en) * | 2008-06-30 | 2011-09-08 | Qualcomm Incorporated | Through Silicon via Bridge Interconnect |
US20100306726A1 (en) * | 2009-06-01 | 2010-12-02 | Ludwig Lester F | Chain/leapfrog circuit topologies and tools for carbon nanotube / graphene nanoribbon nanoelectronics, printed electronics, polymer electronics, and their confluences |
US8671370B2 (en) * | 2009-06-01 | 2014-03-11 | Pike Group Llc | Chain/leapfrog circuit topologies and tools for carbon nanotube/graphene nanoribbon nanoelectronics, printed electronics, polymer electronics, and their confluences |
US8522184B2 (en) | 2010-05-26 | 2013-08-27 | Pike Group Llc | Hierachically-modular nanoelectronic differential amplifiers, op amps, and associated current sources utilizing carbon nanotubes, graphene nanoribbons, printed electronics, polymer semiconductors, or other related materials |
US9490768B2 (en) * | 2012-06-25 | 2016-11-08 | Knowles Cazenovia Inc. | High frequency band pass filter with coupled surface mount transition |
US9812750B2 (en) | 2012-06-25 | 2017-11-07 | Knowles Cazenovia Inc. | High frequency band pass filter with coupled surface mount transition |
US20130342287A1 (en) * | 2012-06-25 | 2013-12-26 | Dielectric Laboratories, Inc. | High frequency band pass filter with coupled surface mount transition |
US9741918B2 (en) | 2013-10-07 | 2017-08-22 | Hypres, Inc. | Method for increasing the integration level of superconducting electronics circuits, and a resulting circuit |
US10283694B2 (en) | 2013-10-07 | 2019-05-07 | Hypres, Inc. | Method for increasing the integration level of superconducting electronics circuits, and a resulting circuit |
US11121165B2 (en) | 2014-09-30 | 2021-09-14 | Apple Inc. | Image sensor with a cross-wafer capacitator |
US10026771B1 (en) * | 2014-09-30 | 2018-07-17 | Apple Inc. | Image sensor with a cross-wafer capacitor |
US10205898B2 (en) | 2014-10-14 | 2019-02-12 | Apple Inc. | Minimizing a data pedestal level in an image sensor |
US9431337B2 (en) | 2015-01-13 | 2016-08-30 | Noda Screen Co., Ltd. | Semiconductor device having an inner power supply plate structure |
US11073712B2 (en) | 2018-04-10 | 2021-07-27 | Apple Inc. | Electronic device display for through-display imaging |
US12069798B1 (en) * | 2021-04-27 | 2024-08-20 | Lockheed Martin Corporation | Broadside coupled radio frequency interconnect |
US11619857B2 (en) | 2021-05-25 | 2023-04-04 | Apple Inc. | Electrically-tunable optical filter |
US12072601B2 (en) | 2021-05-25 | 2024-08-27 | Apple Inc. | Electrically-tunable optical filter |
US20230236230A1 (en) * | 2022-01-24 | 2023-07-27 | Fujikura Ltd. | Evaluation device of radio communication module |
US12114089B2 (en) | 2022-08-19 | 2024-10-08 | Apple Inc. | Pixel output parasitic capacitance reduction and predictive settling assist |
Also Published As
Publication number | Publication date |
---|---|
US7869221B2 (en) | 2011-01-11 |
EP0705529A1 (en) | 1996-04-10 |
EP0705529A4 (en) | 1998-06-24 |
US20080315978A1 (en) | 2008-12-25 |
JP4017186B2 (en) | 2007-12-05 |
JPH09504908A (en) | 1997-05-13 |
US6916719B1 (en) | 2005-07-12 |
US6728113B1 (en) | 2004-04-27 |
JP2004253816A (en) | 2004-09-09 |
JP4083704B2 (en) | 2008-04-30 |
US5629838A (en) | 1997-05-13 |
WO1995001087A1 (en) | 1995-01-05 |
Similar Documents
Publication | Publication Date | Title |
---|---|---|
US7869221B2 (en) | Apparatus for non-conductively interconnecting integrated circuits | |
CN101558491B (en) | Reprogrammable circuit board with alignment-insensitive support for multiple component contact types | |
Davis et al. | Demystifying 3D ICs: The pros and cons of going vertical | |
EP1587141B1 (en) | Method and apparatus involving capacitively coupled communication within a stack of laminated chips | |
US5475264A (en) | Arrangement having multilevel wiring structure used for electronic component module | |
KR20000052705A (en) | A system and method for packaging integrated circuits | |
EP0766909A4 (en) | Vertical interconnect process for silicon segments | |
AU598253B2 (en) | System for detachably mounting semi-conductors on conductor substrates | |
Saltzman et al. | Capacitive coupling solves the known good die problem | |
Wojnarowski et al. | Three dimensional hybrid wafer scale integration using the GE high density interconnect technology | |
Hatamian et al. | Fundamental interconnection issues | |
Val et al. | 3-D interconnection for ultra-dense multichip modules | |
Salzman et al. | Capacitively coupled multichip modules | |
Rymaszewski et al. | Microelectronics packaging—An overview | |
KR20010106420A (en) | Three-dimensional packaging technology for multi-layered integrated circuits | |
Knight et al. | Manufacturability of capacitively coupled multichip modules | |
CHU | A Survey of High Density Packaging for High Performance Computing System | |
Lyke et al. | Space Electronics Packaging Research and Engineering | |
Salzman et al. | Manufacturability of capacitively coupled multichip modules | |
CN118099117A (en) | Chip with reusable passive silicon interposer | |
Ho | High-performance computer packaging and the thin-film multichip module | |
JPH03292763A (en) | Multichip ic assembly body and manufacture thereof | |
Chen et al. | An overview of electrical and mechanical aspects of electronic packaging | |
Herrell et al. | Hybrid wafer scale interconnections | |
Abbasi et al. | The Technology and Manufacture of the VAX-9000 Multichip Unit |
Legal Events
Date | Code | Title | Description |
---|---|---|---|
AS | Assignment |
Owner name: SUN MICROSYSTEMS, INC., CALIFORNIA Free format text: ASSIGNMENT OF ASSIGNORS INTEREST;ASSIGNOR:POLYCHIP, INC.;REEL/FRAME:018826/0953 Effective date: 20070112 |
|
STCB | Information on status: application discontinuation |
Free format text: ABANDONED -- FAILURE TO RESPOND TO AN OFFICE ACTION |